2001-01-23 Kazu Hirata <kazu@hxi.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
6d2ebf8b 2@c Copyright 1988-2000
c906108c
SS
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c
5d161b24 5@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
6@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8@setfilename gdb.info
9@c
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c
c906108c 12@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
13@setchapternewpage odd
14@c %**end of header
15
16@iftex
17@c @smallbook
18@c @cropmarks
19@end iftex
20
21@finalout
22@syncodeindex ky cp
23
41afff9a 24@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 25@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 26@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 27@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
28
29@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
6d2ebf8b 30@set EDITION Eighth
c906108c
SS
31
32@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
6d2ebf8b 33@set DATE March 2000
c906108c 34
6d2ebf8b 35@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 36
c906108c 37@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 38@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
39@dircategory Programming & development tools.
40@direntry
c906108c 41* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
42@end direntry
43
c906108c
SS
44@ifinfo
45This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
46
47
5d161b24 48This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
49of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
50for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
51
6d2ebf8b 52Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c
SS
53
54Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
55this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
56are preserved on all copies.
57
58@ignore
59Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
60results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
61notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
62(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
63
64@end ignore
65Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
66manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
67entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
68permission notice identical to this one.
69
70Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
71into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
72@end ifinfo
73
74@titlepage
75@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
76@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 77@sp 1
c906108c
SS
78@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
79@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 80@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 81@page
c906108c
SS
82@tex
83{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 84\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
85\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
86\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
87}
88@end tex
53a5351d 89
c906108c 90@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
6d2ebf8b 91Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 92@sp 2
c906108c
SS
93Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9459 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
95Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b
SS
96ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
97
c906108c
SS
98Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
99this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
100are preserved on all copies.
101
102Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
103manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
104entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
105permission notice identical to this one.
106
107Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
108into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
109@end titlepage
110@page
111
b9deaee7 112@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
113@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
c906108c
SS
115@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
5d161b24 119This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
120@value{GDBVN}.
121
6d2ebf8b
SS
122Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124@menu
125* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
126* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
127
128* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
129* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
130* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
131* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
132* Stack:: Examining the stack
133* Source:: Examining source files
134* Data:: Examining data
135
136* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
137
138* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
139* Altering:: Altering execution
140* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
141* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
142* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
145* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
146* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 147* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
148
149* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
150* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
151
152* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
153* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
154* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
155* Index:: Index
156@end menu
157
b9deaee7 158@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
159
160@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
161
162@ifhtml
163@node Top
164
165@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
166
167This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
168
169This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
170@value{GDBVN}.
171
172Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
173
c906108c
SS
174@menu
175* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 176* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
177
178* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
179* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
180* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
181* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
182* Stack:: Examining the stack
183* Source:: Examining source files
184* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 185
7a292a7a 186* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
187
188* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
189* Altering:: Altering execution
190* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
191* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 192* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
193* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
194* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 195* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 196* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
c906108c
SS
197
198* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 199* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
200
201* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
202* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
203* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
204* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
205@end menu
206
6d2ebf8b
SS
207@end ifhtml
208
449f3b6c
AC
209@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
210@iftex
211@contents
212@end iftex
213
6d2ebf8b 214@node Summary
c906108c
SS
215@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
216
217The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
218going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
219program was doing at the moment it crashed.
220
221@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
222these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
223
224@itemize @bullet
225@item
226Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
227
228@item
229Make your program stop on specified conditions.
230
231@item
232Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
233
234@item
235Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
236effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
237@end itemize
238
cce74817 239You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 240For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
241For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
242
cce74817
JM
243@cindex Chill
244@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 245Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 246see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 247
cce74817
JM
248@cindex Pascal
249Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
250nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
251entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
252syntax.
c906108c 253
c906108c
SS
254@cindex Fortran
255@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 256it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 257underscore.
c906108c 258
c906108c
SS
259@menu
260* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
261* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
262@end menu
263
6d2ebf8b 264@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
265@unnumberedsec Free software
266
5d161b24 267@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
268General Public License
269(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
270program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
271freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
272the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
273Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
274Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
275
276Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
277you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
278from anyone else.
279
6d2ebf8b 280@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
281@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
282
283Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
284other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
285development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
286of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
287to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
288file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
289blow-by-blow account.
290
291Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
292
293@quotation
294@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
295or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
296omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
297@end quotation
298
299So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
300particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
301releases:
8c70017b 302Andrew Cagney (release 5.0);
c906108c
SS
303Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
304Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
305Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
306Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
307Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
308John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
309Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
310and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
311
312Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
313Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
314
96a2c332
SS
315Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in
316@value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
317Bothner. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on
318C++ was by Peter TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading
319to release 3.0).
c906108c
SS
320
321@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
322object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
323Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
324
325David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
326the original support for encapsulated COFF.
327
96c405b3 328Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
329
330Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
331Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
332support.
333Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
334Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
335Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
336David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
337Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
338Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
339Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
340Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
341Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
342Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
343Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
344Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
345Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
346Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
347Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
348
349Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
350
351Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
352libraries.
353
354Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
355about several machine instruction sets.
356
357Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
358remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
359contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
360and RDI targets, respectively.
361
362Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
363command-line editing and command history.
364
7a292a7a
SS
365Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
366Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 367
5d161b24 368Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
c906108c
SS
369He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
370symbols.
c906108c
SS
371
372Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
373Super-H processors.
374
375NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
376
377Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
378
379Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
380
381Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
382
96a2c332 383Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
384
385Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
386watchpoints.
387
388Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
389
390Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
391
392Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 393nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
394
395The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
396support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
397(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
398compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
399John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
400Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
401information in this manual.
402
96a2c332
SS
403Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
404development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
405fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
406Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
407Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
408Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
409Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
410addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
411JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
412Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
413Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
414Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
415Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
416Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
417Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
418
419
6d2ebf8b 420@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
421@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
422
423You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
424However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
425debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
426
427@iftex
428In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
429to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
430@end iftex
431
432@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
433@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
434
435One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
436processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
437quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
438definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
439session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
440then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
441same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
442@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
443procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
444
445@smallexample
446$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
447$ @b{./m4}
448@b{define(foo,0000)}
449
450@b{foo}
4510000
452@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
453
454@b{bar}
4550000
456@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
457
458@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
459@b{baz}
460@b{C-d}
461m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
462@end smallexample
463
464@noindent
465Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
466
c906108c
SS
467@smallexample
468$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
469@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
470@c FIXME... format to come out better.
471@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 472 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 473 the conditions.
5d161b24 474There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
475 for details.
476
477@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
478(@value{GDBP})
479@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
480
481@noindent
482@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
483rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
484We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
485that examples fit in this manual.
486
487@smallexample
488(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
489@end smallexample
490
491@noindent
492We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
493Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
494@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
495@code{break} command.
496
497@smallexample
498(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
499Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
500@end smallexample
501
502@noindent
503Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
504control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
505subroutine, the program runs as usual:
506
507@smallexample
508(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
509Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
510@b{define(foo,0000)}
511
512@b{foo}
5130000
514@end smallexample
515
516@noindent
517To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
518suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
519context where it stops.
520
521@smallexample
522@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
523
5d161b24 524Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
525 at builtin.c:879
526879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
527@end smallexample
528
529@noindent
530Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
531the next line of the current function.
532
533@smallexample
534(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
535882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
536 : nil,
537@end smallexample
538
539@noindent
540@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
541by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
542@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
543subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
544
545@smallexample
546(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
547set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
548 at input.c:530
549530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
550@end smallexample
551
552@noindent
553The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
554suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
555shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
556command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
557in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
558stack frame for each active subroutine.
559
560@smallexample
561(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
562#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
563 at input.c:530
5d161b24 564#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
565 at builtin.c:882
566#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
567#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
568 at macro.c:71
569#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
570#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
571@end smallexample
572
573@noindent
574We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
575times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
576falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
577
578@smallexample
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5800x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5820x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
583def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
584(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
585536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
586 : xstrdup(rq);
587(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
588538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
589@end smallexample
590
591@noindent
592The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
593@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
594and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
595(@code{print}) to see their values.
596
597@smallexample
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
599$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
600(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
601$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
602@end smallexample
603
604@noindent
605@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
606To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
607surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
608
609@smallexample
610(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
611533 xfree(rquote);
612534
613535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
614 : xstrdup (lq);
615536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
616 : xstrdup (rq);
617537
618538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
619539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
620540 @}
621541
622542 void
623@end smallexample
624
625@noindent
626Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
627@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
628
629@smallexample
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
633540 @}
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
635$3 = 9
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
637$4 = 7
638@end smallexample
639
640@noindent
641That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
642@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
643@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
644the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
645any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
646assignments.
647
648@smallexample
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
650$5 = 7
651(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
652$6 = 9
653@end smallexample
654
655@noindent
656Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
657@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
658executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
659example that caused trouble initially:
660
661@smallexample
662(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
663Continuing.
664
665@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
666
667baz
6680000
669@end smallexample
670
671@noindent
672Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
673problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
674lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
675
676@smallexample
677@b{C-d}
678Program exited normally.
679@end smallexample
680
681@noindent
682The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
683indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
684session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
685
686@smallexample
687(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
688@end smallexample
c906108c 689
6d2ebf8b 690@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
691@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
692
693This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 694The essentials are:
c906108c 695@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 696@item
53a5351d 697type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 698@item
c906108c
SS
699type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
700@end itemize
701
702@menu
703* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
704* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
705* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
706@end menu
707
6d2ebf8b 708@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
709@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
710
c906108c
SS
711Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
712@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
713
714You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
715to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
716
c906108c
SS
717The command-line options described here are designed
718to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 719options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
720
721The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
722specifying an executable program:
723
724@example
725@value{GDBP} @var{program}
726@end example
727
c906108c
SS
728@noindent
729You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
730specified:
731
732@example
733@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
734@end example
735
736You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
737to debug a running process:
738
739@example
740@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
741@end example
742
743@noindent
744would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
745named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
746
c906108c 747Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
748complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
749debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
750``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
751will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 752
96a2c332 753You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
754@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
755
756@smallexample
757@value{GDBP} -silent
758@end smallexample
759
760@noindent
761You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
762options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
763
764@noindent
765Type
766
767@example
768@value{GDBP} -help
769@end example
770
771@noindent
772to display all available options and briefly describe their use
773(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
774
775All options and command line arguments you give are processed
776in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
777@samp{-x} option is used.
778
779
780@menu
c906108c
SS
781* File Options:: Choosing files
782* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
783@end menu
784
6d2ebf8b 785@node File Options
c906108c
SS
786@subsection Choosing files
787
2df3850c 788When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
789specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
790the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
791@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
792that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
793@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
794that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
795the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
796
797If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
798such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
799argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
800
801Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
802following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
803them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
804(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
805than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
806
d700128c
EZ
807@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
808@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
809@c it.
810
c906108c
SS
811@table @code
812@item -symbols @var{file}
813@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
814@cindex @code{--symbols}
815@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
816Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
817
818@item -exec @var{file}
819@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
820@cindex @code{--exec}
821@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
822Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
823and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
824
825@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 826@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
827Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
828file.
829
c906108c
SS
830@item -core @var{file}
831@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
832@cindex @code{--core}
833@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
834Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
835
836@item -c @var{number}
837Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
838(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
839case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
840
841@item -command @var{file}
842@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
843@cindex @code{--command}
844@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
845Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
846Files,, Command files}.
847
848@item -directory @var{directory}
849@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
850@cindex @code{--directory}
851@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
852Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
853
c906108c
SS
854@item -m
855@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
856@cindex @code{--mapped}
857@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
858@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
859supported on all systems.}@*
860If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 861system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
862to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
863program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 864called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
865Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
866and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
867the symbol table from the executable program.
868
869The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
870is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
871table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 872
c906108c
SS
873@item -r
874@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
875@cindex @code{--readnow}
876@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
877Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
878the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
879This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 880
c906108c
SS
881@end table
882
2df3850c 883You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 884order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
885information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
886on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
887but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
888
889@example
2df3850c 890gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 891@end example
c906108c 892
6d2ebf8b 893@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
894@subsection Choosing modes
895
896You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
897batch mode or quiet mode.
898
899@table @code
900@item -nx
901@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
902@cindex @code{--nx}
903@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
904Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
905called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
906@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
907options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
908files}.
c906108c
SS
909
910@item -quiet
d700128c 911@itemx -silent
c906108c 912@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
913@cindex @code{--quiet}
914@cindex @code{--silent}
915@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
916``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
917messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
918
919@item -batch
d700128c 920@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
921Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
922command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
923initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
924nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
925in the command files.
926
2df3850c
JM
927Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
928example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
929make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
930
931@example
932Program exited normally.
933@end example
934
935@noindent
2df3850c
JM
936(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
937@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
938mode.
939
940@item -nowindows
941@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
942@cindex @code{--nowindows}
943@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 944``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 945(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
946interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
947
948@item -windows
949@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
950@cindex @code{--windows}
951@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
952If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
953used if possible.
c906108c
SS
954
955@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 956@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
957Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
958instead of the current directory.
959
c906108c
SS
960@item -fullname
961@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
962@cindex @code{--fullname}
963@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
964@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
965subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
966number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
967displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
968recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
969the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
970and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
971@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
972frame.
c906108c 973
d700128c
EZ
974@item -epoch
975@cindex @code{--epoch}
976The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
977@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
978routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
979separate window.
980
981@item -annotate @var{level}
982@cindex @code{--annotate}
983This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
984effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
985(@pxref{Annotations}).
986Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
987together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
988types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
989@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
990maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
991
992@item -async
993@cindex @code{--async}
994Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
995@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
996special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
997commands in parallel with the debugged process being
998run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
999MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1000suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1001control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1002(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.0, the target side of the asynchronous
1003operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1004yet.)
1005@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1006@c should be removed.
1007
1008When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1009uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1010@samp{-noasync} option.
1011
1012@item -noasync
1013@cindex @code{--noasync}
1014Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1015
2df3850c
JM
1016@item -baud @var{bps}
1017@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1018@cindex @code{--baud}
1019@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1020Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1021interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1022
1023@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1024@itemx -t @var{device}
1025@cindex @code{--tty}
1026@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1027Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1028@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1029
53a5351d
JM
1030@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1031@c @item -tui
d700128c 1032@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
1033@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1034@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1035@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1036@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1037@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1038
1039@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1040@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1041@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1042@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1043@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1044@c systems.
1045
d700128c
EZ
1046@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1047@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1048Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1049program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1050communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1051@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
7162c0ca 1052interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
d700128c
EZ
1053
1054@item -write
1055@cindex @code{--write}
1056Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1057is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1058(@pxref{Patching}).
1059
1060@item -statistics
1061@cindex @code{--statistics}
1062This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1063memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1064
1065@item -version
1066@cindex @code{--version}
1067This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1068no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1069
c906108c
SS
1070@end table
1071
6d2ebf8b 1072@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1073@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1074@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1075@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1076
1077@table @code
1078@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1079@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1080@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1081@itemx q
1082To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1083@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1084do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1085otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1086error code.
c906108c
SS
1087@end table
1088
1089@cindex interrupt
1090An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1091terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1092returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1093character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1094until a time when it is safe.
1095
c906108c
SS
1096If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1097device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1098(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1099
6d2ebf8b 1100@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1101@section Shell commands
1102
1103If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1104debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1105just use the @code{shell} command.
1106
1107@table @code
1108@kindex shell
1109@cindex shell escape
1110@item shell @var{command string}
1111Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1112If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1113shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1114(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1115@end table
1116
1117The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1118You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1119@value{GDBN}:
1120
1121@table @code
1122@kindex make
1123@cindex calling make
1124@item make @var{make-args}
1125Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1126arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1127@end table
1128
6d2ebf8b 1129@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1130@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1131
1132You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1133name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1134@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1135key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1136show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1137
1138@menu
1139* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1140* Completion:: Command completion
1141* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1142@end menu
1143
6d2ebf8b 1144@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1145@section Command syntax
1146
1147A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1148how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1149arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1150command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1151step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1152with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1153
1154@cindex abbreviation
1155@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1156unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1157documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1158abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1159equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1160names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1161arguments to the @code{help} command.
1162
1163@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1164@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1165A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1166repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1167will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1168repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1169repeat.
1170
1171The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1172@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1173exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1174
1175@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1176output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1177(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1178@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1179repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1180
41afff9a 1181@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1182@cindex comment
1183Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1184nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1185Files,,Command files}).
1186
6d2ebf8b 1187@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1188@section Command completion
1189
1190@cindex completion
1191@cindex word completion
1192@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1193only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1194are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1195commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1196
1197Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1198of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1199word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1200enter it). For example, if you type
1201
1202@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1203@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1204@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1205@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1206@example
1207(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1208@end example
1209
1210@noindent
1211@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1212the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1213
1214@example
1215(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1216@end example
1217
1218@noindent
1219You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1220breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1221@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1222were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1223might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1224to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1225
1226If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1227@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1228characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1229@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1230example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1231begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1232just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1233function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1234example:
1235
1236@example
1237(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1238@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1239make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1240make_abs_section make_function_type
1241make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1242make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1243make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1244(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1245@end example
1246
1247@noindent
1248After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1249partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1250command.
1251
1252If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1253can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1254means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1255key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1256one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1257
1258@cindex quotes in commands
1259@cindex completion of quoted strings
1260Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1261parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1262its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1263situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1264@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1265
c906108c
SS
1266The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1267name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1268(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1269type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1270distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1271@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1272@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1273facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1274beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1275consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1276@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1277
1278@example
96a2c332 1279(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1280bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1281(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1282@end example
1283
1284In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1285quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1286completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1287place:
1288
1289@example
1290(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1291@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1292(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1293@end example
1294
1295@noindent
1296In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1297you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1298completion on an overloaded symbol.
1299
d4f3574e 1300For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
c906108c
SS
1301expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1302overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
d4f3574e 1303see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
c906108c
SS
1304
1305
6d2ebf8b 1306@node Help
c906108c
SS
1307@section Getting help
1308@cindex online documentation
1309@kindex help
1310
5d161b24 1311You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1312using the command @code{help}.
1313
1314@table @code
41afff9a 1315@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1316@item help
1317@itemx h
1318You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1319display a short list of named classes of commands:
1320
1321@smallexample
1322(@value{GDBP}) help
1323List of classes of commands:
1324
2df3850c 1325aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1326breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1327data -- Examining data
c906108c 1328files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1329internals -- Maintenance commands
1330obscure -- Obscure features
1331running -- Running the program
1332stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1333status -- Status inquiries
1334support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1335tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1336 stopping the program
c906108c 1337user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1338
5d161b24 1339Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1340commands in that class.
5d161b24 1341Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1342documentation.
1343Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1344(@value{GDBP})
1345@end smallexample
96a2c332 1346@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1347
1348@item help @var{class}
1349Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1350list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1351help display for the class @code{status}:
1352
1353@smallexample
1354(@value{GDBP}) help status
1355Status inquiries.
1356
1357List of commands:
1358
1359@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1360@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1361info -- Generic command for showing things
1362 about the program being debugged
1363show -- Generic command for showing things
1364 about the debugger
c906108c 1365
5d161b24 1366Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1367documentation.
1368Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1369(@value{GDBP})
1370@end smallexample
1371
1372@item help @var{command}
1373With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1374short paragraph on how to use that command.
1375
6837a0a2
DB
1376@kindex apropos
1377@item apropos @var{args}
1378The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1379commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1380@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1381
1382@smallexample
1383apropos reload
1384@end smallexample
1385
1386@noindent results in:
1387
1388@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1389@c @group
1390set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1391 multiple times in one run
1392show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1393 multiple times in one run
1394@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1395@end smallexample
1396
c906108c
SS
1397@kindex complete
1398@item complete @var{args}
1399The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1400for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1401command you want completed. For example:
1402
1403@smallexample
1404complete i
1405@end smallexample
1406
1407@noindent results in:
1408
1409@smallexample
1410@group
2df3850c
JM
1411if
1412ignore
c906108c
SS
1413info
1414inspect
c906108c
SS
1415@end group
1416@end smallexample
1417
1418@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1419@end table
1420
1421In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1422and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1423of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1424manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1425under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1426all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1427
1428@c @group
1429@table @code
1430@kindex info
41afff9a 1431@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1432@item info
1433This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1434program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1435with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1436registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1437You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1438@w{@code{help info}}.
1439
1440@kindex set
1441@item set
5d161b24 1442You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1443@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1444@code{set prompt $}.
1445
1446@kindex show
1447@item show
5d161b24 1448In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1449@value{GDBN} itself.
1450You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1451related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1452system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1453which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1454
1455@kindex info set
1456To display all the settable parameters and their current
1457values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1458@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1459@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1460@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1461@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1462@end table
1463@c @end group
1464
1465Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1466exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1467
1468@table @code
1469@kindex show version
1470@cindex version number
1471@item show version
1472Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1473information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1474@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1475version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1476commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1477system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1478variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1479The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1480@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1481
1482@kindex show copying
1483@item show copying
1484Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1485
1486@kindex show warranty
1487@item show warranty
2df3850c 1488Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1489if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1490
c906108c
SS
1491@end table
1492
6d2ebf8b 1493@node Running
c906108c
SS
1494@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1495
1496When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1497debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1498
1499You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1500of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1501your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1502kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1503
1504@menu
1505* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1506* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1507* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1508* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1509
1510* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1511* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1512* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1513* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1514
1515* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1516* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1517@end menu
1518
6d2ebf8b 1519@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1520@section Compiling for debugging
1521
1522In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1523debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1524is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1525variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1526and addresses in the executable code.
1527
1528To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1529the compiler.
1530
1531Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1532options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1533executables containing debugging information.
1534
53a5351d
JM
1535@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1536without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1537recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1538program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1539in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1540
1541@cindex optimized code, debugging
1542@cindex debugging optimized code
1543When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1544optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1545really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1546exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1547variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1548variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1549
1550Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1551@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1552doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1553please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1554
1555Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1556@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1557format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1558
1559@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1560@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1561@section Starting your program
1562@cindex starting
1563@cindex running
1564
1565@table @code
1566@kindex run
41afff9a 1567@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1568@item run
1569@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1570Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1571You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1572argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1573@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1574(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1575
1576@end table
1577
c906108c
SS
1578If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1579supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1580that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1581@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1582
1583The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1584receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1585information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1586can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1587your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1588divided into four categories:
1589
1590@table @asis
1591@item The @emph{arguments.}
1592Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1593@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1594is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1595(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1596the arguments.
1597In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1598@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1599@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1600
1601@item The @emph{environment.}
1602Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1603use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1604environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1605your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1606
1607@item The @emph{working directory.}
1608Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1609the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1610@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1611
1612@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1613Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1614standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1615in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1616set a different device for your program.
1617@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1618
1619@cindex pipes
1620@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1621pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1622program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1623wrong program.
1624@end table
c906108c
SS
1625
1626When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1627immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1628of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1629stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1630or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1631
1632If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1633time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1634table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1635your current breakpoints.
1636
6d2ebf8b 1637@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1638@section Your program's arguments
1639
1640@cindex arguments (to your program)
1641The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1642@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1643They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1644performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1645@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1646@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1647the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1648
1649On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1650@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1651calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1652the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1653
1654@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1655@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1656
c906108c 1657@table @code
41afff9a 1658@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1659@item set args
1660Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1661@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1662with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1663using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1664it again without arguments.
1665
1666@kindex show args
1667@item show args
1668Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1669@end table
1670
6d2ebf8b 1671@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1672@section Your program's environment
1673
1674@cindex environment (of your program)
1675The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1676their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1677your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1678path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1679the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1680debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1681environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1682
1683@table @code
1684@kindex path
1685@item path @var{directory}
1686Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1687(the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
d4f3574e
SS
1688You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1689system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1690MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1691is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1692
1693You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1694working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1695use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1696@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1697@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1698@var{directory} to the search path.
1699@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1700@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1701
1702@kindex show paths
1703@item show paths
1704Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1705environment variable).
1706
1707@kindex show environment
1708@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1709Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1710your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1711print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1712your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1713
1714@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1715@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1716Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1717changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1718be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1719any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1720parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1721null value.
1722@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1723@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1724
1725For example, this command:
1726
1727@example
1728set env USER = foo
1729@end example
1730
1731@noindent
d4f3574e 1732tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1733@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1734are not actually required.)
1735
1736@kindex unset environment
1737@item unset environment @var{varname}
1738Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1739program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1740@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1741rather than assigning it an empty value.
1742@end table
1743
d4f3574e
SS
1744@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1745the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1746by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1747@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1748that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1749@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1750your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1751files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1752@file{.profile}.
1753
6d2ebf8b 1754@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1755@section Your program's working directory
1756
1757@cindex working directory (of your program)
1758Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1759working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1760The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1761from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1762working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1763
1764The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1765that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1766specify files}.
1767
1768@table @code
1769@kindex cd
1770@item cd @var{directory}
1771Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1772
1773@kindex pwd
1774@item pwd
1775Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1776@end table
1777
6d2ebf8b 1778@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1779@section Your program's input and output
1780
1781@cindex redirection
1782@cindex i/o
1783@cindex terminal
1784By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1785the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1786to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1787modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1788running your program.
1789
1790@table @code
1791@kindex info terminal
1792@item info terminal
1793Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1794program is using.
1795@end table
1796
1797You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1798redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1799
1800@example
1801run > outfile
1802@end example
1803
1804@noindent
1805starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1806
1807@kindex tty
1808@cindex controlling terminal
1809Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1810with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1811argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1812commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1813process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1814
1815@example
1816tty /dev/ttyb
1817@end example
1818
1819@noindent
1820directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1821default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1822that as their controlling terminal.
1823
1824An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1825effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1826terminal.
1827
1828When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1829command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1830for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1831
6d2ebf8b 1832@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1833@section Debugging an already-running process
1834@kindex attach
1835@cindex attach
1836
1837@table @code
1838@item attach @var{process-id}
1839This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1840outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1841targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1842find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1843or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1844
1845@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1846executing the command.
1847@end table
1848
1849To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1850which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1851programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1852also have permission to send the process a signal.
1853
1854When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1855the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1856the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1857(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1858the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1859Specify Files}.
1860
1861The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1862process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1863with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1864you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1865can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1866process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1867attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1868
1869@table @code
1870@kindex detach
1871@item detach
1872When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1873@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1874the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1875that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1876are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1877@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1878executing the command.
1879@end table
1880
1881If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1882attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1883for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1884control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1885confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1886messages}).
1887
6d2ebf8b 1888@node Kill Process
c906108c 1889@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1890
1891@table @code
1892@kindex kill
1893@item kill
1894Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1895@end table
1896
1897This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1898running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1899is running.
1900
1901On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1902while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1903@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1904outside the debugger.
1905
1906The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1907relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1908executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1909next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1910reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1911breakpoint settings).
1912
6d2ebf8b 1913@node Threads
c906108c 1914@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1915
1916@cindex threads of execution
1917@cindex multiple threads
1918@cindex switching threads
1919In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1920may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1921of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1922the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1923that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1924modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1925registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1926
1927@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1928programs:
1929
1930@itemize @bullet
1931@item automatic notification of new threads
1932@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1933@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1934@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1935a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1936@item thread-specific breakpoints
1937@end itemize
1938
c906108c
SS
1939@quotation
1940@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1941@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1942If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1943effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1944from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1945like this:
1946
1947@smallexample
1948(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1949(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1950Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1951see the IDs of currently known threads.
1952@end smallexample
1953@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1954@c doesn't support threads"?
1955@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1956
1957@cindex focus of debugging
1958@cindex current thread
1959The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1960threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1961control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1962This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1963program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1964
41afff9a 1965@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1966@cindex thread identifier (system)
1967@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1968@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1969@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1970Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1971the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1972form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1973whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1974LynxOS, you might see
1975
1976@example
1977[New process 35 thread 27]
1978@end example
1979
1980@noindent
1981when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1982the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1983further qualifier.
1984
1985@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1986@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1987@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1988@c program?
1989@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1990@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1991@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
1992
1993@cindex thread number
1994@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1995For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1996number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1997
1998@table @code
1999@kindex info threads
2000@item info threads
2001Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2002program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2003
2004@enumerate
2005@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2006
2007@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2008
2009@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2010@end enumerate
2011
2012@noindent
2013An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2014indicates the current thread.
2015
5d161b24 2016For example,
c906108c
SS
2017@end table
2018@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2019
2020@smallexample
2021(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2022 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2023 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2024* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2025 at threadtest.c:68
2026@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2027
2028On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2029
2030@cindex thread number
2031@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2032For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2033number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2034thread in your program.
2035
41afff9a
EZ
2036@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2037@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2038@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2039@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2040@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2041Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2042both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2043form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2044whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2045HP-UX, you see
2046
2047@example
2048[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2049@end example
2050
2051@noindent
5d161b24 2052when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2053
2054@table @code
2055@kindex info threads
2056@item info threads
2057Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2058program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2059
2060@enumerate
2061@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2062
2063@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2064
2065@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2066@end enumerate
2067
2068@noindent
2069An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2070indicates the current thread.
2071
5d161b24 2072For example,
c906108c
SS
2073@end table
2074@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2075
2076@example
2077(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2078 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2079 at quicksort.c:137
2080 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2081 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2082 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2083 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2084@end example
c906108c
SS
2085
2086@table @code
2087@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2088@item thread @var{threadno}
2089Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2090argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2091shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2092@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2093you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2094
2095@smallexample
2096@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2097(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2098[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2100@end smallexample
2101
2102@noindent
2103As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2104@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2105threads.
c906108c
SS
2106
2107@kindex thread apply
2108@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2109The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2110more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2111with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2112@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2113threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2114@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2115@end table
2116
2117@cindex automatic thread selection
2118@cindex switching threads automatically
2119@cindex threads, automatic switching
2120Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2121signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2122signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2123message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2124thread.
2125
2126@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2127more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2128programs with multiple threads.
2129
2130@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2131watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2132
6d2ebf8b 2133@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2134@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2135
2136@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2137@cindex multiple processes
2138@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2139On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2140programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2141function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2142parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2143set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2144will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2145will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2146
2147However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2148which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2149the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2150only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2151so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2152on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2153get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2154@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2155the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2156the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2157
53a5351d
JM
2158On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2159debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2160@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2161
2162By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2163the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2164
2165If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2166use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2167
2168@table @code
2169@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2170@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2171Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2172@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2173process. The @var{mode} can be:
2174
2175@table @code
2176@item parent
2177The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2178unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2179
2180@item child
2181The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2182unimpeded.
2183
2184@item ask
2185The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2186@end table
2187
2188@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2189Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2190@end table
2191
2192If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2193@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2194breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2195@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2196the child process's @code{main}.
2197
2198When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2199child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2200
2201If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2202call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2203use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2204argument.
2205
2206You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2207a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2208Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2209
6d2ebf8b 2210@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2211@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2212
2213The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2214program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2215trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2216
7a292a7a
SS
2217Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2218such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2219@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2220change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2221continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2222ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2223explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2224
2225@table @code
2226@kindex info program
2227@item info program
2228Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2229running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2230@end table
2231
2232@menu
2233* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2234* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2235* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2236* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2237@end menu
2238
6d2ebf8b 2239@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2240@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2241
2242@cindex breakpoints
2243A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2244the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2245control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2246breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2247Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2248should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2249program.
2250
2251In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2252breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2253a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2254is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2255not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2256arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2257
2258@cindex watchpoints
2259@cindex memory tracing
2260@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2261@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2262A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2263when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2264command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2265watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2266any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2267and watchpoints using the same commands.
2268
2269You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2270whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2271Automatic display}.
2272
2273@cindex catchpoints
2274@cindex breakpoint on events
2275A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2276when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2277exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2278different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2279catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2280other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2281@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2282
2283@cindex breakpoint numbers
2284@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2285@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2286catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2287starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2288features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2289breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2290@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2291enable it again.
2292
c5394b80
JM
2293@cindex breakpoint ranges
2294@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2295Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2296operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2297@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2298hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2299all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2300
c906108c
SS
2301@menu
2302* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2303* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2304* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2305* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2306* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2307* Conditions:: Break conditions
2308* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2309* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2310* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2311@end menu
2312
6d2ebf8b 2313@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2314@subsection Setting breakpoints
2315
5d161b24 2316@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2317@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2318@c
2319@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2320
2321@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2322@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2323@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2324@cindex latest breakpoint
2325Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2326@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2327number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2328Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2329convenience variables.
2330
2331You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2332
2333@table @code
2334@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2335Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c
SS
2336When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2337C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2338@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2339
2340@item break +@var{offset}
2341@itemx break -@var{offset}
2342Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2343at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2344(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2345
2346@item break @var{linenum}
2347Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2348The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2349The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2350code on that line.
2351
2352@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2353Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2354
2355@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2356Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2357@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2358superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2359functions.
2360
2361@item break *@var{address}
2362Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2363breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2364information or source files.
2365
2366@item break
2367When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2368the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2369(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2370innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2371returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2372@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2373that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2374@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2375the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2376inside loops.
2377
2378@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2379least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2380would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2381breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2382existed when your program stopped.
2383
2384@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2385Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2386@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2387value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2388@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2389above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2390,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2391
2392@kindex tbreak
2393@item tbreak @var{args}
2394Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2395same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2396way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2397program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2398
c906108c
SS
2399@kindex hbreak
2400@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2401Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2402@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2403breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2404have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2405debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2406changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2407provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2408will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2409address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2410breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2411example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2412@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2413or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2414(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2415
2416@kindex thbreak
2417@item thbreak @var{args}
2418Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2419are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2420the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2421the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2422first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2423command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2424may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2425See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2426
2427@kindex rbreak
2428@cindex regular expression
2429@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2430Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2431@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2432matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2433breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2434the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2435them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2436
2437The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2438like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2439shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2440an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2441@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2442match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2443
c906108c
SS
2444When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2445breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2446classes.
c906108c
SS
2447
2448@kindex info breakpoints
2449@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2450@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2451@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2452@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2453Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2454not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2455
2456@table @emph
2457@item Breakpoint Numbers
2458@item Type
2459Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2460@item Disposition
2461Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2462@item Enabled or Disabled
2463Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2464that are not enabled.
2465@item Address
2df3850c 2466Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2467@item What
2468Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2469line number.
2470@end table
2471
2472@noindent
2473If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2474the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2475are listed after that.
2476
2477@noindent
2478@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2479number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2480convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2481the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2482listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2483
2484@noindent
2485@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2486has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2487@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2488hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2489was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2490will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2491@end table
2492
2493@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2494your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2495the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2496(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2497
2498@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2499@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2500@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2501purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2502These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2503@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2504
2505You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2506@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2507
2508@table @code
2509@kindex maint info breakpoints
2510@item maint info breakpoints
2511Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2512breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2513internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2514breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2515is shown:
2516
2517@table @code
2518@item breakpoint
2519Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2520
2521@item watchpoint
2522Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2523
2524@item longjmp
2525Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2526@code{longjmp} calls.
2527
2528@item longjmp resume
2529Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2530
2531@item until
2532Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2533
2534@item finish
2535Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2536
c906108c
SS
2537@item shlib events
2538Shared library events.
53a5351d 2539
c906108c 2540@end table
53a5351d 2541
c906108c
SS
2542@end table
2543
2544
6d2ebf8b 2545@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2546@subsection Setting watchpoints
2547
2548@cindex setting watchpoints
2549@cindex software watchpoints
2550@cindex hardware watchpoints
2551You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2552expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2553this may happen.
2554
2555Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2556hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2557program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2558times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2559catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2560culprit.)
2561
d4f3574e 2562On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2563@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2564hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2565program.
2566
2567@table @code
2568@kindex watch
2569@item watch @var{expr}
2570Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2571is written into by the program and its value changes.
2572
2573@kindex rwatch
2574@item rwatch @var{expr}
2575Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2576
2577@kindex awatch
2578@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2579Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2580by the program.
c906108c
SS
2581
2582@kindex info watchpoints
2583@item info watchpoints
2584This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2585it is the same as @code{info break}.
2586@end table
2587
2588@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2589watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2590value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2591cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2592executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2593statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2594
2595When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2596
2597@example
2598Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2599@end example
2600
2601@noindent
2602if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2603
7be570e7
JM
2604Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2605hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2606value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2607every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2608that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2609hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2610will print a message like this:
2611
2612@smallexample
2613Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2614@end smallexample
2615
2616Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2617data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2618watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2619can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2620cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2621double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2622wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2623into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2624
2625If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2626to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2627Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2628time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2629able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2630warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2631
2632@smallexample
2633Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2634@end smallexample
2635
2636@noindent
2637If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2638
2639The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2640or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2641data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2642hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2643both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2644watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2645@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2646watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2647@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2648Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2649
2650If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2651any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2652kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2653
7be570e7
JM
2654@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2655(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2656they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2657which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2658being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2659and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2660rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2661way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2662@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2663
c906108c
SS
2664@quotation
2665@cindex watchpoints and threads
2666@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2667@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2668usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2669can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2670you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2671thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2672can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2673@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2674the expression.
53a5351d 2675
d4f3574e 2676@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2677@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2678have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2679watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2680single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2681change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2682confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2683software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2684when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2685watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2686@end quotation
c906108c 2687
6d2ebf8b 2688@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2689@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2690@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2691@cindex exception handlers
2692@cindex event handling
2693
2694You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2695kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2696shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2697
2698@table @code
2699@kindex catch
2700@item catch @var{event}
2701Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2702@table @code
2703@item throw
2704@kindex catch throw
2705The throwing of a C++ exception.
2706
2707@item catch
2708@kindex catch catch
2709The catching of a C++ exception.
2710
2711@item exec
2712@kindex catch exec
2713A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2714
2715@item fork
2716@kindex catch fork
2717A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2718
2719@item vfork
2720@kindex catch vfork
2721A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2722
2723@item load
2724@itemx load @var{libname}
2725@kindex catch load
2726The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2727@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2728
2729@item unload
2730@itemx unload @var{libname}
2731@kindex catch unload
2732The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2733of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2734@end table
2735
2736@item tcatch @var{event}
2737Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2738automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2739
2740@end table
2741
2742Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2743
2744There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2745(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2746
2747@itemize @bullet
2748@item
2749If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2750control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2751raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2752returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2753simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2754that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2755you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2756disabled within interactive calls.
2757
2758@item
2759You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2760
2761@item
2762You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2763@end itemize
2764
2765@cindex raise exceptions
2766Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2767if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2768stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2769can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2770breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2771out where the exception was raised.
2772
2773To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2774knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2775raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2776which has the following ANSI C interface:
2777
2778@example
2779 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2780 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2781 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2782@end example
2783
2784@noindent
2785To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2786unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2787(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2788
2789With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2790that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2791a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2792breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2793raised.
2794
2795
6d2ebf8b 2796@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2797@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2798
2799@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2800@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2801It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2802catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2803to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2804breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2805
2806With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2807where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2808delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2809their breakpoint numbers.
2810
2811It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2812automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2813when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2814
2815@table @code
2816@kindex clear
2817@item clear
2818Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2819selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2820the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2821breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2822
2823@item clear @var{function}
2824@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2825Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2826
2827@item clear @var{linenum}
2828@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2829Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2830
2831@cindex delete breakpoints
2832@kindex delete
41afff9a 2833@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2834@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2835Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2836ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2837breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2838confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2839@end table
2840
6d2ebf8b 2841@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2842@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2843
2844@kindex disable breakpoints
2845@kindex enable breakpoints
2846Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2847prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2848it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2849that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2850
2851You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2852the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2853or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2854@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2855catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2856
2857A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2858states of enablement:
2859
2860@itemize @bullet
2861@item
2862Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2863with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2864@item
2865Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2866@item
2867Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2868disabled.
c906108c
SS
2869@item
2870Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2871immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2872set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2873@end itemize
2874
2875You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2876watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex disable breakpoints
2880@kindex disable
41afff9a 2881@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2882@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2883Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2884listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2885options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2886case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2887@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2888
2889@kindex enable breakpoints
2890@kindex enable
c5394b80 2891@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2892Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2893become effective once again in stopping your program.
2894
c5394b80 2895@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2896Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2897of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2898
c5394b80 2899@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2900Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2901deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2902@end table
2903
d4f3574e
SS
2904@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2905@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2906Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2907,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2908subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2909the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2910breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2911breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2912stepping}.)
2913
6d2ebf8b 2914@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2915@subsection Break conditions
2916@cindex conditional breakpoints
2917@cindex breakpoint conditions
2918
2919@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2920@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2921The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2922specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2923breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2924programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2925a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2926and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2927
2928This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2929situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2930when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2931by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2932@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2933
2934Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2935since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2936it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2937and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2938one.
2939
2940Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2941your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2942that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2943format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2944unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2945that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2946program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2947breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2948conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2949purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2950(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2951
2952Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2953@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2954Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2955with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2956
c906108c
SS
2957You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2958The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2959@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2960catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2961
2962@table @code
2963@kindex condition
2964@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2965Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2966watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2967breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2968@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2969@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2970syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2971referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2972symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2973prints an error message:
2974
2975@example
2976No symbol "foo" in current context.
2977@end example
2978
2979@noindent
c906108c
SS
2980@value{GDBN} does
2981not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2982command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2983@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2984
2985@item condition @var{bnum}
2986Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2987an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2988@end table
2989
2990@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2991A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2992breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2993useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2994count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2995is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2996therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2997ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2998the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2999value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3000your program reaches it.
3001
3002@table @code
3003@kindex ignore
3004@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3005Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3006The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3007execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3008takes no action.
3009
3010To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3011a count of zero.
3012
3013When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3014breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3015@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3016Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3017
3018If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3019condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3020@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3021
3022You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3023as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3024is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3025variables}.
3026@end table
3027
3028Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3029
3030
6d2ebf8b 3031@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3032@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3033
3034@cindex breakpoint commands
3035You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3036commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3037example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3038enable other breakpoints.
3039
3040@table @code
3041@kindex commands
3042@kindex end
3043@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3044@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3045@itemx end
3046Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3047themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3048@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3049
3050To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3051follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3052
3053With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3054breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3055recently encountered).
3056@end table
3057
3058Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3059disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3060
3061You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3062use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3063that resumes execution.
3064
3065Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3066execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3067(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3068another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3069ambiguities about which list to execute.
3070
3071@kindex silent
3072If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3073usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3074be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3075then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3076see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3077meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3078
3079The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3080print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3081breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3082
3083For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3084value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3085
3086@example
3087break foo if x>0
3088commands
3089silent
3090printf "x is %d\n",x
3091cont
3092end
3093@end example
3094
3095One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3096you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3097of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3098erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3099to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3100so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3101command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3102
3103@example
3104break 403
3105commands
3106silent
3107set x = y + 4
3108cont
3109end
3110@end example
3111
6d2ebf8b 3112@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3113@subsection Breakpoint menus
3114@cindex overloading
3115@cindex symbol overloading
3116
3117Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
3118to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3119This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3120@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3121a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3122something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3123particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3124you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3125waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3126options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3127sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3128@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3129breakpoints.
3130
3131For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3132breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3133We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3134
3135@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3136@smallexample
3137@group
3138(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3139[0] cancel
3140[1] all
3141[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3142[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3143[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3144[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3145[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3146[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3147> 2 4 6
3148Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3149Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3150Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3151Multiple breakpoints were set.
3152Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3153 breakpoints.
3154(@value{GDBP})
3155@end group
3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3159@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3160@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3161@c
3162@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3163@c
d4f3574e
SS
3164Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3165any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3166attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3167@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3168
3169@example
3170Cannot insert breakpoints.
3171The same program may be running in another process.
3172@end example
3173
3174When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3175
3176@enumerate
3177@item
3178Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3179
3180@item
5d161b24 3181Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3182name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3183that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3184Then start your program again.
3185
3186@item
3187Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3188linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3189to nonsharable executables.
3190@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3191@c @end ifclear
3192
d4f3574e
SS
3193A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3194hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3195
3196@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3197@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3198@smallexample
3199Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3200You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3201@end smallexample
3202
3203@noindent
3204This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3205only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3206watchpoints it needs to insert.
3207
3208When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3209hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3210
3211
6d2ebf8b 3212@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3213@section Continuing and stepping
3214
3215@cindex stepping
3216@cindex continuing
3217@cindex resuming execution
3218@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3219completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3220one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3221line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3222particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3223your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3224it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3225@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3226
3227@table @code
3228@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3229@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3230@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3231@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3232@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3233@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3234Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3235any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3236@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3237ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3238@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3239
3240The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3241stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3242@code{continue} is ignored.
3243
d4f3574e
SS
3244The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3245debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3246purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3247@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3248@end table
3249
3250To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3251(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3252calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3253different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3254
3255A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3256(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3257beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3258is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3259and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3260interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3261
3262@table @code
3263@kindex step
41afff9a 3264@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3265@item step
3266Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3267line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3268abbreviated @code{s}.
3269
3270@quotation
3271@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3272@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3273@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3274@c distinction here.
3275@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3276within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3277execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3278debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3279is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3280without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3281below.
3282@end quotation
3283
4a92d011
EZ
3284The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3285line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3286@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3287to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3288the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3289called within the line.
c906108c 3290
d4f3574e
SS
3291Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3292number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3293@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3294on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3295was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3296
3297@item step @var{count}
3298Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3299breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3300@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3301
3302@kindex next
41afff9a 3303@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3304@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3305Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3306This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3307the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3308control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3309that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3310is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3311
3312An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3313
3314
3315@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3316@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3317@c
3318@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3319@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3320@c function are executed without stopping.
3321
d4f3574e
SS
3322The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3323source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3324@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3325
b90a5f51
CF
3326@kindex set step-mode
3327@item set step-mode
3328@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3329@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3330@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3331The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3332stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3333information rather than stepping over it.
3334
4a92d011
EZ
3335This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3336machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3337want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3338
3339@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3340Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3341debug information. This is the default.
3342
c906108c
SS
3343@kindex finish
3344@item finish
3345Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3346returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3347
3348Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3349,Returning from a function}).
3350
3351@kindex until
41afff9a 3352@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3353@item until
3354@itemx u
3355Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3356current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3357stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3358command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3359automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3360than the address of the jump.
3361
3362This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3363though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3364exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3365simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3366through the next iteration.
3367
3368@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3369stack frame.
3370
3371@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3372of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3373example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3374(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3375@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3376
3377@example
3378(@value{GDBP}) f
3379#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3380206 expand_input();
3381(@value{GDBP}) until
3382195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3383@end example
3384
3385This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3386generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3387start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3388written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3389to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3390expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3391statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3392
3393@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3394instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3395argument.
3396
3397@item until @var{location}
3398@itemx u @var{location}
3399Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3400reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3401the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3402,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3403and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3404
3405@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3406@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3407@item stepi
96a2c332 3408@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3409@itemx si
3410Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3411
3412It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3413instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3414instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3415Display,, Automatic display}.
3416
3417An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3418
3419@need 750
3420@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3421@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3422@item nexti
96a2c332 3423@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3424@itemx ni
3425Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3426proceed until the function returns.
3427
3428An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3429@end table
3430
6d2ebf8b 3431@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3432@section Signals
3433@cindex signals
3434
3435A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3436operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3437kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3438signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3439@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3440memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3441the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3442requested an alarm).
3443
3444@cindex fatal signals
3445Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3446functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3447errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3448program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3449@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3450fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3451
3452@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3453program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3454signal.
3455
3456@cindex handling signals
3457Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3458(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3459but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3460You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3461
3462@table @code
3463@kindex info signals
3464@item info signals
96a2c332 3465@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3466Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3467handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3468the defined types of signals.
3469
d4f3574e 3470@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3471
3472@kindex handle
3473@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5d161b24 3474Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
c906108c
SS
3475be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3476beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3477@end table
3478
3479@c @group
3480The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3481Their full names are:
3482
3483@table @code
3484@item nostop
3485@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3486still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3487
3488@item stop
3489@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3490the @code{print} keyword as well.
3491
3492@item print
3493@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3494
3495@item noprint
3496@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3497implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3498
3499@item pass
3500@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3501can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3502and not handled.
3503
3504@item nopass
3505@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3506@end table
3507@c @end group
3508
d4f3574e
SS
3509When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3510program until you
c906108c
SS
3511continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3512effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3513after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3514command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3515program sees that signal when you continue.
3516
3517You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3518seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3519or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3520due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3521values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3522execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3523a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3524you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3525program a signal}.
c906108c 3526
6d2ebf8b 3527@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3528@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3529
3530When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3531programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3532breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3533
3534@table @code
3535@cindex breakpoints and threads
3536@cindex thread breakpoints
3537@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3538@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3539@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3540@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3541writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3542
3543Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3544to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3545particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3546numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3547column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3548
3549If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3550breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3551program.
3552
3553You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3554well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3555breakpoint condition, like this:
3556
3557@smallexample
2df3850c 3558(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3559@end smallexample
3560
3561@end table
3562
3563@cindex stopped threads
3564@cindex threads, stopped
3565Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3566@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3567allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3568switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3569underfoot.
3570
3571@cindex continuing threads
3572@cindex threads, continuing
3573Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3574executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3575like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3576
3577In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3578Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3579system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3580execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3581single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3582statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3583stops.
3584
3585You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3586continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3587thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3588first thread completes whatever you requested.
3589
3590On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3591thread to run.
3592
3593@table @code
3594@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3595Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3596locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3597current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3598mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3599``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3600stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3601when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3602function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3603like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3604thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3605@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3606
3607@item show scheduler-locking
3608Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3609@end table
3610
c906108c 3611
6d2ebf8b 3612@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3613@chapter Examining the Stack
3614
3615When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3616stopped and how it got there.
3617
3618@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3619Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3620is generated.
3621That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3622the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3623and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3624The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3625The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3626stack}.
3627
3628When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3629stack allow you to see all of this information.
3630
3631@cindex selected frame
3632One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3633@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3634particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3635your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3636special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3637interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3638
3639When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3640currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3641@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3642
3643@menu
3644* Frames:: Stack frames
3645* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3646* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3647* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3648
3649@end menu
3650
6d2ebf8b 3651@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3652@section Stack frames
3653
d4f3574e 3654@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3655@cindex stack frame
3656The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3657frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3658with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3659to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3660which the function is executing.
3661
3662@cindex initial frame
3663@cindex outermost frame
3664@cindex innermost frame
3665When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3666function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3667@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3668made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3669is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3670the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3671actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3672recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3673
3674@cindex frame pointer
3675Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3676stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3677kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3678address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3679in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3680going on in that frame.
3681
3682@cindex frame number
3683@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3684zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3685and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3686they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3687frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3688
6d2ebf8b
SS
3689@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3690@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3691@cindex frameless execution
3692Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3693without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3694@example
3695@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3696@end example
3697generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3698This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3699the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3700with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3701has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3702it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3703correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3704no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3705
3706@table @code
d4f3574e 3707@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3708@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3709@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3710The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3711and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3712address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3713@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3714
3715@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3716@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3717@item select-frame
3718The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3719to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3720@code{frame}.
3721@end table
3722
6d2ebf8b 3723@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3724@section Backtraces
3725
3726@cindex backtraces
3727@cindex tracebacks
3728@cindex stack traces
3729A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3730line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3731frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3732stack.
3733
3734@table @code
3735@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3736@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3737@item backtrace
3738@itemx bt
3739Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3740frames in the stack.
3741
3742You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3743character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3744
3745@item backtrace @var{n}
3746@itemx bt @var{n}
3747Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3748
3749@item backtrace -@var{n}
3750@itemx bt -@var{n}
3751Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3752@end table
3753
3754@kindex where
3755@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3756@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3757The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3758are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3759
3760Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3761The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3762print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3763line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3764counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3765line number.
3766
3767Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3768@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3769
3770@smallexample
3771@group
5d161b24 3772#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3773 at builtin.c:993
3774#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3775#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3776 at macro.c:71
3777(More stack frames follow...)
3778@end group
3779@end smallexample
3780
3781@noindent
3782The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3783value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3784code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3785
6d2ebf8b 3786@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3787@section Selecting a frame
3788
3789Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3790whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3791selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3792of the stack frame just selected.
3793
3794@table @code
d4f3574e 3795@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3796@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3797@item frame @var{n}
3798@itemx f @var{n}
3799Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3800(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3801innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3802@code{main}.
3803
3804@item frame @var{addr}
3805@itemx f @var{addr}
3806Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3807chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3808impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3809addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3810switches between them.
3811
c906108c
SS
3812On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3813select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3814
3815On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3816pointer and a program counter.
3817
3818On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3819pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3820@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3821@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3822@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3823
3824@kindex up
3825@item up @var{n}
3826Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3827advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3828that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3829
3830@kindex down
41afff9a 3831@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3832@item down @var{n}
3833Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3834advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3835that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3836abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3837@end table
3838
3839All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3840frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3841arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3842frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3843
3844@need 1000
3845For example:
3846
3847@smallexample
3848@group
3849(@value{GDBP}) up
3850#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3851 at env.c:10
385210 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3853@end group
3854@end smallexample
3855
3856After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3857prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3858@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3859
3860@table @code
3861@kindex down-silently
3862@kindex up-silently
3863@item up-silently @var{n}
3864@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3865These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3866respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3867causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3868in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3869distracting.
3870@end table
3871
6d2ebf8b 3872@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3873@section Information about a frame
3874
3875There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3876stack frame.
3877
3878@table @code
3879@item frame
3880@itemx f
3881When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3882frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3883selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3884argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3885@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3886
3887@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3888@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3889@item info frame
3890@itemx info f
3891This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3892including:
3893
3894@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3895@item
3896the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3897@item
3898the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3899@item
3900the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3901@item
3902the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3903@item
3904the address of the frame's arguments
3905@item
d4f3574e
SS
3906the address of the frame's local variables
3907@item
c906108c
SS
3908the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3909@item
3910which registers were saved in the frame
3911@end itemize
3912
3913@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3914something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3915the usual conventions.
3916
3917@item info frame @var{addr}
3918@itemx info f @var{addr}
3919Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3920selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3921command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3922architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3923@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3924
3925@kindex info args
3926@item info args
3927Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3928
3929@item info locals
3930@kindex info locals
3931Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3932line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3933accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3934
c906108c 3935@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3936@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3937@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3938@item info catch
3939Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3940current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3941exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3942@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3943@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3944
c906108c
SS
3945@end table
3946
c906108c 3947
6d2ebf8b 3948@node Source
c906108c
SS
3949@chapter Examining Source Files
3950
3951@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3952information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3953used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3954the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3955(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3956execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3957source files by explicit command.
3958
7a292a7a 3959If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3960prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3961@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3962
3963@menu
3964* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3965* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3966* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3967* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3968@end menu
3969
6d2ebf8b 3970@node List
c906108c
SS
3971@section Printing source lines
3972
3973@kindex list
41afff9a 3974@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3975To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3976(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3977There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3978
3979Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3980
3981@table @code
3982@item list @var{linenum}
3983Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3984current source file.
3985
3986@item list @var{function}
3987Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3988@var{function}.
3989
3990@item list
3991Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3992@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3993printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3994as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3995Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3996
3997@item list -
3998Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3999@end table
4000
4001By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4002the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4003
4004@table @code
4005@kindex set listsize
4006@item set listsize @var{count}
4007Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4008the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4009
4010@kindex show listsize
4011@item show listsize
4012Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4013@end table
4014
4015Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4016so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4017than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4018argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4019each repetition moves up in the source file.
4020
4021@cindex linespec
4022In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4023@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4024of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4025Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4026
4027@table @code
4028@item list @var{linespec}
4029Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4030
4031@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4032Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4033linespecs.
4034
4035@item list ,@var{last}
4036Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4037
4038@item list @var{first},
4039Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4040
4041@item list +
4042Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4043
4044@item list -
4045Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4046
4047@item list
4048As described in the preceding table.
4049@end table
4050
4051Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4052kinds of linespec.
4053
4054@table @code
4055@item @var{number}
4056Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4057When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4058the same source file as the first linespec.
4059
4060@item +@var{offset}
4061Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4062When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4063two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4064first linespec.
4065
4066@item -@var{offset}
4067Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4068
4069@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4070Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4071
4072@item @var{function}
4073Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4074For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4075
4076@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4077Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4078function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4079file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4080identically named functions in different source files.
4081
4082@item *@var{address}
4083Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4084@var{address} may be any expression.
4085@end table
4086
6d2ebf8b 4087@node Search
c906108c
SS
4088@section Searching source files
4089@cindex searching
4090@kindex reverse-search
4091
4092There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4093regular expression.
4094
4095@table @code
4096@kindex search
4097@kindex forward-search
4098@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4099@itemx search @var{regexp}
4100The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4101starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4102@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4103synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4104@code{fo}.
4105
4106@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4107The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4108with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4109for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4110this command as @code{rev}.
4111@end table
c906108c 4112
6d2ebf8b 4113@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4114@section Specifying source directories
4115
4116@cindex source path
4117@cindex directories for source files
4118Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4119files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4120the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4121session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4122this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4123it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4124in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4125the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4126the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4127path.
4128
4129If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4130object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4131too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4132compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4133last resort.
4134
4135Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4136any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4137each line is in the file.
4138
4139@kindex directory
4140@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4141When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4142and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4143To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4144
4145@table @code
4146@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4147@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4148Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4149directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4150(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4151part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4152whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4153path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4154
4155@kindex cdir
4156@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4157@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4158@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4159@cindex compilation directory
4160@cindex current directory
4161@cindex working directory
4162@cindex directory, current
4163@cindex directory, compilation
4164You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4165directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4166working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4167tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4168session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4169directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4170
4171@item directory
4172Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4173
4174@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4175@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4176
4177@item show directories
4178@kindex show directories
4179Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4180@end table
4181
4182If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4183interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4184versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4185
4186@enumerate
4187@item
4188Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4189
4190@item
4191Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4192directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4193directories in one command.
4194@end enumerate
4195
6d2ebf8b 4196@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4197@section Source and machine code
4198
4199You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4200addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4201a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4202mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4203line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4204well as hex.
4205
4206@table @code
4207@kindex info line
4208@item info line @var{linespec}
4209Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4210source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4211the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4212source lines}).
4213@end table
4214
4215For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4216the object code for the first line of function
4217@code{m4_changequote}:
4218
d4f3574e
SS
4219@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4220@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4221@smallexample
96a2c332 4222(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4223Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4224@end smallexample
4225
4226@noindent
4227We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4228@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4229@smallexample
4230(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4231Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4232@end smallexample
4233
4234@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4235@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4236After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4237is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4238sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4239,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4240convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4241variables}).
4242
4243@table @code
4244@kindex disassemble
4245@cindex assembly instructions
4246@cindex instructions, assembly
4247@cindex machine instructions
4248@cindex listing machine instructions
4249@item disassemble
4250This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4251instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4252program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4253command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4254surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4255(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4256@end table
4257
c906108c
SS
4258The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4259HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4260
4261@smallexample
4262(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4263Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42640x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42650x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42660x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42670x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42680x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42690x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42700x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42710x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4272End of assembler dump.
4273@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4274
4275Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4276mnemonics or other syntax.
4277
4278@table @code
d4f3574e 4279@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4280@cindex assembly instructions
4281@cindex instructions, assembly
4282@cindex machine instructions
4283@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4284@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4285@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4286@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4287Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4288program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4289
4290Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4291can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4292The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4293assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4294@end table
4295
4296
6d2ebf8b 4297@node Data
c906108c
SS
4298@chapter Examining Data
4299
4300@cindex printing data
4301@cindex examining data
4302@kindex print
4303@kindex inspect
4304@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4305@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4306@c different window or something like that.
4307The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4308command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4309evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4310program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4311Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4312
4313@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4314@item print @var{expr}
4315@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4316@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4317value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4318you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4319@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4320formats}.
4321
4322@item print
4323@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4324If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4325@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4326conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4327@end table
4328
4329A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4330It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4331specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4332
7a292a7a 4333If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4334fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4335command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4336Table}.
c906108c
SS
4337
4338@menu
4339* Expressions:: Expressions
4340* Variables:: Program variables
4341* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4342* Output Formats:: Output formats
4343* Memory:: Examining memory
4344* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4345* Print Settings:: Print settings
4346* Value History:: Value history
4347* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4348* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4349* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
c906108c
SS
4350@end menu
4351
6d2ebf8b 4352@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4353@section Expressions
4354
4355@cindex expressions
4356@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4357compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4358by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4359@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4360and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4361by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4362
d4f3574e
SS
4363@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4364the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4365you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4366memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4367
c906108c
SS
4368Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4369this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4370Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4371languages.
4372
4373In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4374expressions regardless of your programming language.
4375
4376Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4377useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4378at that address in memory.
4379@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4380
4381@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4382to programming languages:
4383
4384@table @code
4385@item @@
4386@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4387@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4388
4389@item ::
4390@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4391function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4392
4393@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4394@cindex type casting memory
4395@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4396@cindex casts, to view memory
4397@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4398Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4399memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4400pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4401a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4402normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4403@end table
4404
6d2ebf8b 4405@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4406@section Program variables
4407
4408The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4409in your program.
4410
4411Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4412(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4413
4414@itemize @bullet
4415@item
4416global (or file-static)
4417@end itemize
4418
5d161b24 4419@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4420
4421@itemize @bullet
4422@item
4423visible according to the scope rules of the
4424programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4425@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4426
4427@noindent This means that in the function
4428
4429@example
4430foo (a)
4431 int a;
4432@{
4433 bar (a);
4434 @{
4435 int b = test ();
4436 bar (b);
4437 @}
4438@}
4439@end example
4440
4441@noindent
4442you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4443executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4444examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4445the block where @code{b} is declared.
4446
4447@cindex variable name conflict
4448There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4449scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4450in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4451function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4452happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4453you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4454using the colon-colon notation:
4455
d4f3574e 4456@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4457@iftex
4458@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4459@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4460@end iftex
4461@example
4462@var{file}::@var{variable}
4463@var{function}::@var{variable}
4464@end example
4465
4466@noindent
4467Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4468static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4469make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4470to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4471
4472@example
4473(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4474@end example
4475
c906108c
SS
4476@cindex C++ scope resolution
4477This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4478use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4479scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4480@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4481@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4482
4483@cindex wrong values
4484@cindex variable values, wrong
4485@quotation
4486@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4487wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4488scope, and just before exit.
4489@end quotation
4490You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4491This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4492set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4493stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4494values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4495also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4496after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4497variable definitions may be gone.
4498
4499This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4500To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4501when compiling.
4502
d4f3574e
SS
4503@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4504Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4505unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4506opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4507offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4508might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4509happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4510
4511@example
4512No symbol "foo" in current context.
4513@end example
4514
4515To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4516different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4517formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4518supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4519in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4520to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4521debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4522Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4523information.
4524
4525
6d2ebf8b 4526@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4527@section Artificial arrays
4528
4529@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4530@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4531It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4532same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4533dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4534program.
4535
4536You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4537@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4538operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4539and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4540of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4541the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4542argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4543following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4544example. If a program says
4545
4546@example
4547int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4548@end example
4549
4550@noindent
4551you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4552
4553@example
4554p *array@@len
4555@end example
4556
4557The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4558with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4559subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4560Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4561(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4562
4563Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4564This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4565The value need not be in memory:
4566@example
4567(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4568$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4569@end example
4570
4571As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4572@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4573the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4574@example
4575(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4576$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4577@end example
4578
4579Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4580moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4581actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4582of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4583to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4584variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4585interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4586instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4587structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4588in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4589
4590@example
4591set $i = 0
4592p dtab[$i++]->fv
4593@key{RET}
4594@key{RET}
4595@dots{}
4596@end example
4597
6d2ebf8b 4598@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4599@section Output formats
4600
4601@cindex formatted output
4602@cindex output formats
4603By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4604this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4605in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4606at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4607these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4608
4609The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4610already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4611@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4612letters supported are:
4613
4614@table @code
4615@item x
4616Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4617hexadecimal.
4618
4619@item d
4620Print as integer in signed decimal.
4621
4622@item u
4623Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4624
4625@item o
4626Print as integer in octal.
4627
4628@item t
4629Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4630@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4631used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4632see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4633
4634@item a
4635@cindex unknown address, locating
4636Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4637the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4638where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4639
4640@example
4641(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4642$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4643@end example
4644
4645@item c
4646Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4647
4648@item f
4649Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4650using typical floating point syntax.
4651@end table
4652
4653For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4654
4655@example
4656p/x $pc
4657@end example
4658
4659@noindent
4660Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4661names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4662
4663To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4664you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4665expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4666
6d2ebf8b 4667@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4668@section Examining memory
4669
4670You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4671any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4672
4673@cindex examining memory
4674@table @code
41afff9a 4675@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4676@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4677@itemx x @var{addr}
4678@itemx x
4679Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4680@end table
4681
4682@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4683much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4684expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4685If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4686Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4687
4688@table @r
4689@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4690The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4691how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4692@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4693@c 4.1.2.
4694
4695@item @var{f}, the display format
4696The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4697@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4698The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4699The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4700
4701@item @var{u}, the unit size
4702The unit size is any of
4703
4704@table @code
4705@item b
4706Bytes.
4707@item h
4708Halfwords (two bytes).
4709@item w
4710Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4711@item g
4712Giant words (eight bytes).
4713@end table
4714
4715Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4716default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4717@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4718
4719@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4720@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4721memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4722it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4723@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4724@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4725other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4726the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4727starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4728a value from memory).
4729@end table
4730
4731For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4732(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4733starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4734words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4735@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4736
4737Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4738letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4739unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4740specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4741(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4742
4743Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4744and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4745@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4746including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4747alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4748Code,,Source and machine code}.
4749
4750All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4751easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4752you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4753instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4754with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4755the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4756for successive uses of @code{x}.
4757
4758@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4759The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4760in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4761would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4762subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4763@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4764examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4765@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4766the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4767
4768If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4769are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4770address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4771
6d2ebf8b 4772@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4773@section Automatic display
4774@cindex automatic display
4775@cindex display of expressions
4776
4777If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4778(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4779display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4780Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4781to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4782The automatic display looks like this:
4783
4784@example
47852: foo = 38
47863: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4787@end example
4788
4789@noindent
4790This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4791displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4792specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4793whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4794format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4795or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4796supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4797
4798@table @code
4799@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4800@item display @var{expr}
4801Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4802each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4803
4804@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4805
d4f3574e 4806@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4807For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4808count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4809arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4810@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4811
4812@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4813For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4814number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4815be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4816doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4817@end table
4818
4819For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4820instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4821is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4822
4823@table @code
4824@kindex delete display
4825@kindex undisplay
4826@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4827@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4828Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4829
4830@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4831(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4832
4833@kindex disable display
4834@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4835Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4836item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4837enabled again later.
4838
4839@kindex enable display
4840@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4841Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4842again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4843
4844@item display
4845Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4846done when your program stops.
4847
4848@kindex info display
4849@item info display
4850Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4851automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4852values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4853It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4854because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4855@end table
4856
4857If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4858sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4859expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4860variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4861@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4862@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4863continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4864there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4865automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4866is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4867
6d2ebf8b 4868@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4869@section Print settings
4870
4871@cindex format options
4872@cindex print settings
4873@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4874and symbols are printed.
4875
4876@noindent
4877These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4878
4879@table @code
4880@kindex set print address
4881@item set print address
4882@itemx set print address on
4883@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4884traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4885even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4886is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4887@code{set print address on}:
4888
4889@smallexample
4890@group
4891(@value{GDBP}) f
4892#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4893 at input.c:530
4894530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4895@end group
4896@end smallexample
4897
4898@item set print address off
4899Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4900this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4901
4902@smallexample
4903@group
4904(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4905(@value{GDBP}) f
4906#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4907530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4908@end group
4909@end smallexample
4910
4911You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4912dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4913@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4914all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4915
4916@kindex show print address
4917@item show print address
4918Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4919@end table
4920
4921When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4922closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4923identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4924source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4925@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4926you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4927it prints a symbolic address:
4928
4929@table @code
4930@kindex set print symbol-filename
4931@item set print symbol-filename on
4932Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4933symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4934
4935@item set print symbol-filename off
4936Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4937default.
4938
4939@kindex show print symbol-filename
4940@item show print symbol-filename
4941Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4942line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4943@end table
4944
4945Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4946numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4947number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4948
4949Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4950printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4951
4952@table @code
4953@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4954@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4955Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4956offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4957@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4958to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4959
4960@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4961@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4962Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4963symbolic address.
4964@end table
4965
4966@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4967@cindex pointer, finding referent
4968If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4969@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4970and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4971@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4972For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4973at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4974
4975@example
4976(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4977(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4978$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4979@end example
4980
4981@quotation
4982@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4983does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4984the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4985@end quotation
4986
4987Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4988
4989@table @code
4990@kindex set print array
4991@item set print array
4992@itemx set print array on
4993Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4994but uses more space. The default is off.
4995
4996@item set print array off
4997Return to compressed format for arrays.
4998
4999@kindex show print array
5000@item show print array
5001Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5002arrays.
5003
5004@kindex set print elements
5005@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5006Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5007If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5008printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5009This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5010When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5011Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5012
5013@kindex show print elements
5014@item show print elements
5015Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5016If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5017
5018@kindex set print null-stop
5019@item set print null-stop
5020Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5021@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5022contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5023The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5024
5025@kindex set print pretty
5026@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5027Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5028per line, like this:
5029
5030@smallexample
5031@group
5032$1 = @{
5033 next = 0x0,
5034 flags = @{
5035 sweet = 1,
5036 sour = 1
5037 @},
5038 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5039@}
5040@end group
5041@end smallexample
5042
5043@item set print pretty off
5044Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5045
5046@smallexample
5047@group
5048$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5049meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5050@end group
5051@end smallexample
5052
5053@noindent
5054This is the default format.
5055
5056@kindex show print pretty
5057@item show print pretty
5058Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5059
5060@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5061@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5062Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5063@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5064character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5065best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5066high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5067
5068@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5069Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5070international character sets, and is the default.
5071
5072@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5073@item show print sevenbit-strings
5074Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5075
5076@kindex set print union
5077@item set print union on
5d161b24 5078Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5079is the default setting.
5080
5081@item set print union off
5082Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5083
5084@kindex show print union
5085@item show print union
5086Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5087structures.
5088
5089For example, given the declarations
5090
5091@smallexample
5092typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5093typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5094typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5095 Bug_forms;
5096
5097struct thing @{
5098 Species it;
5099 union @{
5100 Tree_forms tree;
5101 Bug_forms bug;
5102 @} form;
5103@};
5104
5105struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5106@end smallexample
5107
5108@noindent
5109with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5110
5111@smallexample
5112$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5113@end smallexample
5114
5115@noindent
5116and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5117
5118@smallexample
5119$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5120@end smallexample
5121@end table
5122
c906108c
SS
5123@need 1000
5124@noindent
5125These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
5126
5127@table @code
5128@cindex demangling
5129@kindex set print demangle
5130@item set print demangle
5131@itemx set print demangle on
5132Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5133(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5134linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5135
5136@kindex show print demangle
5137@item show print demangle
5138Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5139
5140@kindex set print asm-demangle
5141@item set print asm-demangle
5142@itemx set print asm-demangle on
5143Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5144in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5145The default is off.
5146
5147@kindex show print asm-demangle
5148@item show print asm-demangle
5149Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5150or demangled form.
5151
5152@kindex set demangle-style
5153@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
5154@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
5155@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5156Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5157represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5158
5159@table @code
5160@item auto
5161Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5162
5163@item gnu
5d161b24 5164Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5165This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5166
5167@item hp
5168Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5169
5170@item lucid
5171Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5172
5173@item arm
5174Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
5175@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5176debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5177require further enhancement to permit that.
5178
5179@end table
5180If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5181
5182@kindex show demangle-style
5183@item show demangle-style
5184Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
5185
5186@kindex set print object
5187@item set print object
5188@itemx set print object on
5189When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5190(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5191the virtual function table.
5192
5193@item set print object off
5194Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5195virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5196
5197@kindex show print object
5198@item show print object
5199Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5200
5201@kindex set print static-members
5202@item set print static-members
5203@itemx set print static-members on
5204Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
5205
5206@item set print static-members off
5207Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
5208
5209@kindex show print static-members
5210@item show print static-members
5211Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
5212
5213@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5214@kindex set print vtbl
5215@item set print vtbl
5216@itemx set print vtbl on
5217Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5218(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5219ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5220
5221@item set print vtbl off
5222Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5223
5224@kindex show print vtbl
5225@item show print vtbl
5226Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5227@end table
c906108c 5228
6d2ebf8b 5229@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5230@section Value history
5231
5232@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5233Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5234@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5235Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5236(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5237When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5238since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5239symbol table.
5240
5241@cindex @code{$}
5242@cindex @code{$$}
5243@cindex history number
5244The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5245refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5246@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5247printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5248history number.
5249
5250To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5251history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5252remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5253the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5254@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5255is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5256@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5257
5258For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5259want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5260
5261@example
5262p *$
5263@end example
5264
5265If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5266to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5267
5268@example
5269p *$.next
5270@end example
5271
5272@noindent
5273You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5274command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5275
5276Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5277@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5278
5279@example
5280print x
5281set x=5
5282@end example
5283
5284@noindent
5285then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5286remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5287
5288@table @code
5289@kindex show values
5290@item show values
5291Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5292This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5293values} does not change the history.
5294
5295@item show values @var{n}
5296Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5297
5298@item show values +
5299Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5300values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5301@end table
5302
5303Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5304same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5305
6d2ebf8b 5306@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5307@section Convenience variables
5308
5309@cindex convenience variables
5310@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5311@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5312exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5313setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5314of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5315
5316Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5317@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5318the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5319(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5320by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5321
5322You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5323expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5324For example:
5325
5326@example
5327set $foo = *object_ptr
5328@end example
5329
5330@noindent
5331would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5332@code{object_ptr}.
5333
5334Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5335value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5336value with another assignment at any time.
5337
5338Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5339variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5340that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5341variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5342
5343@table @code
5344@kindex show convenience
5345@item show convenience
5346Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5347Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5348@end table
5349
5350One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5351incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5352a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5353
5354@example
5355set $i = 0
5356print bar[$i++]->contents
5357@end example
5358
d4f3574e
SS
5359@noindent
5360Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5361
5362Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5363values likely to be useful.
5364
5365@table @code
41afff9a 5366@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5367@item $_
5368The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5369the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5370commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5371set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5372and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5373except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5374to the type of @code{$__}.
5375
41afff9a 5376@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5377@item $__
5378The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5379to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5380to match the format in which the data was printed.
5381
5382@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5383@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5384The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5385the program being debugged terminates.
5386@end table
5387
53a5351d
JM
5388On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5389begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5390name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5391
6d2ebf8b 5392@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5393@section Registers
5394
5395@cindex registers
5396You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5397with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5398for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5399your machine.
5400
5401@table @code
5402@kindex info registers
5403@item info registers
5404Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5405registers (in the selected stack frame).
5406
5407@kindex info all-registers
5408@cindex floating point registers
5409@item info all-registers
5410Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5411registers.
5412
5413@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5414Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5415As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5416the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5417the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5418@end table
5419
5420@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5421expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5422architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5423@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5424the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5425pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5426register that contains the processor status. For example,
5427you could print the program counter in hex with
5428
5429@example
5430p/x $pc
5431@end example
5432
5433@noindent
5434or print the instruction to be executed next with
5435
5436@example
5437x/i $pc
5438@end example
5439
5440@noindent
5441or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5442one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5443memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5444stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5445stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5446regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5447see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5448
5449@example
5450set $sp += 4
5451@end example
5452
5453Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5454your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5455so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5456shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5457registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5458can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5459is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5460
5461@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5462integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5463special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5464registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5465to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5466(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5467@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5468
5469Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5470means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5471the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5472sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5473coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5474programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5475cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5476that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5477prints the data in both formats.
5478
5479Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5480(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5481value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5482were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5483true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5484frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5485
5486However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5487code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5488@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5489frame makes no difference.
5490
6d2ebf8b 5491@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5492@section Floating point hardware
5493@cindex floating point
5494
5495Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5496you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5497
5498@table @code
5499@kindex info float
5500@item info float
5501Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5502point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5503floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5504the ARM and x86 machines.
5505@end table
c906108c 5506
6d2ebf8b 5507@node Languages
c906108c
SS
5508@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5509@cindex languages
5510
c906108c
SS
5511Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5512rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5513dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5514Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 5515represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 5516@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
5517
5518@cindex working language
5519Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5520allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5521native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5522consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5523language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5524language}.
5525
5526@menu
5527* Setting:: Switching between source languages
5528* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 5529* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5530* Support:: Supported languages
5531@end menu
5532
6d2ebf8b 5533@node Setting
c906108c
SS
5534@section Switching between source languages
5535
5536There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5537set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5538@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5539defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5540used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5541are printed, etc.
5542
5543In addition to the working language, every source file that
5544@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5545file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5546source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5547language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5548controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5549show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
5550set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5551set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5552Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
5553
5554This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 5555as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
5556another language. In that case, make the
5557program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5558@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5559program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5560
5561@menu
5562* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5563* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5564* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5565@end menu
5566
6d2ebf8b 5567@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
5568@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5569
5570If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5571@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5572
5573@table @file
5574
5575@item .c
5576C source file
5577
5578@item .C
5579@itemx .cc
5580@itemx .cp
5581@itemx .cpp
5582@itemx .cxx
5583@itemx .c++
5584C++ source file
5585
5586@item .f
5587@itemx .F
5588Fortran source file
5589
c906108c
SS
5590@item .ch
5591@itemx .c186
5592@itemx .c286
96a2c332 5593CHILL source file
c906108c 5594
c906108c
SS
5595@item .mod
5596Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
5597
5598@item .s
5599@itemx .S
5600Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5601@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5602@end table
5603
5604In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5605extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5606
6d2ebf8b 5607@node Manually
c906108c
SS
5608@subsection Setting the working language
5609
5610If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5611expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5612your program.
5613
5614@kindex set language
5615If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5616command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 5617a language, such as
c906108c 5618@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
5619For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5620
c906108c
SS
5621Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5622language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5623to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5624source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5625languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5626source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5627command such as:
5628
5629@example
5630print a = b + c
5631@end example
5632
5633@noindent
5634might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5635@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5636printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5637@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 5638
6d2ebf8b 5639@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
5640@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5641
5642To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5643@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5644then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5645frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5646working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5647frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5648or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5649does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5650not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5651
5652This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5653entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5654written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5655a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5656case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5657
6d2ebf8b 5658@node Show
c906108c 5659@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
5660
5661The following commands help you find out which language is the
5662working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5663
5664@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
5665@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5666@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
5667@table @code
5668@item show language
5669Display the current working language. This is the
5670language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5671build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5672
5673@item info frame
5d161b24 5674Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 5675working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 5676@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
5677information listed here.
5678
5679@item info source
5680Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 5681@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
5682information listed here.
5683@end table
5684
5685In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5686not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5687with a language explicitly:
5688
5689@kindex set extension-language
5690@kindex info extensions
5691@table @code
5692@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5693Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5694the source language @var{language}.
5695
5696@item info extensions
5697List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5698@end table
5699
6d2ebf8b 5700@node Checks
c906108c
SS
5701@section Type and range checking
5702
5703@quotation
5704@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5705checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5706section documents the intended facilities.
5707@end quotation
5708@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5709
5710Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5711errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5712checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5713sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5714these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5715by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5716errors when your program is running.
5717
5718@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5719Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5720can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5721the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5722@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5723your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5724for the default settings of supported languages.
5725
5726@menu
5727* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5728* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5729@end menu
5730
5731@cindex type checking
5732@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 5733@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
5734@subsection An overview of type checking
5735
5736Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5737arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5738otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5739errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5740
5741@smallexample
57421 + 2 @result{} 3
5743@exdent but
5744@error{} 1 + 2.3
5745@end smallexample
5746
5747The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5748type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5749
5d161b24
DB
5750For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5751@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5752to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5753or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
5754but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5755these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5756also issues a warning.
5757
5d161b24
DB
5758Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5759related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5760For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5761a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5762with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
5763the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5764
5765Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5766instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5767operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5768represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5769operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5770details on specific languages.
5771
5772@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5773
d4f3574e 5774@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
5775@kindex set check type
5776@kindex show check type
5777@table @code
5778@item set check type auto
5779Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5780@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5781each language.
5782
5783@item set check type on
5784@itemx set check type off
5785Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5786current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5787match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 5788evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
5789message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5790
5791@item set check type warn
5792Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5793evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5794be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5795numbers and structures.
5796
5797@item show type
5d161b24 5798Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5799is setting it automatically.
5800@end table
5801
5802@cindex range checking
5803@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 5804@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
5805@subsection An overview of range checking
5806
5807In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5808bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5809checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5810computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5811not exceed the bounds of the array.
5812
5813For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5814@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5815always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5816warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5817
5818A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5819array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5820of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5821error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5822result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5823the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5824
5825@example
5826@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5827@end example
5828
5829This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5830specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5831Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5832
5833@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5834
d4f3574e 5835@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
5836@kindex set check range
5837@kindex show check range
5838@table @code
5839@item set check range auto
5840Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5841@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5842each language.
5843
5844@item set check range on
5845@itemx set check range off
5846Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5847current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
5848match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5849then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
5850
5851@item set check range warn
5852Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5853but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5854expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5855memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5856systems).
5857
5858@item show range
5859Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5860being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5861@end table
c906108c 5862
6d2ebf8b 5863@node Support
c906108c 5864@section Supported languages
c906108c 5865
cce74817
JM
5866@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5867@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
5868Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5869language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5870and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5871,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5872language.
5873
5874The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5875supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5876tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5877@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5878formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5879books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5880language reference or tutorial.
5881
c906108c 5882@menu
7a292a7a 5883* C:: C and C++
cce74817 5884* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 5885* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
5886@end menu
5887
6d2ebf8b 5888@node C
c906108c 5889@subsection C and C++
7a292a7a 5890
c906108c
SS
5891@cindex C and C++
5892@cindex expressions in C or C++
c906108c
SS
5893
5894Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5895to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5896together.
5897
41afff9a
EZ
5898@cindex C@t{++}
5899@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
c906108c
SS
5900@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5901The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5902compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5903effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5904C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5905compiler (@code{aCC}).
5906
5907For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5908format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5909command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5910@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5911CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 5912
c906108c
SS
5913@menu
5914* C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5915* C Constants:: C and C++ constants
7a292a7a 5916* C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
c906108c 5917* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
c906108c 5918* C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5919* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5920* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5921@end menu
c906108c 5922
6d2ebf8b 5923@node C Operators
c906108c 5924@subsubsection C and C++ operators
7a292a7a
SS
5925
5926@cindex C and C++ operators
c906108c
SS
5927
5928Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5929@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 5930often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 5931
c906108c 5932For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
5933
5934@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 5935
c906108c 5936@item
c906108c
SS
5937@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5938specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
5939
5940@item
d4f3574e
SS
5941@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5942@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
5943
5944@item
53a5351d 5945@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
5946
5947@item
5948@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 5949
c906108c
SS
5950@end itemize
5951
5952@noindent
5953The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5954in order of increasing precedence:
5955
5956@table @code
5957@item ,
5958The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5959are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5960expression being the last expression evaluated.
5961
5962@item =
5963Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5964assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5965
5966@item @var{op}=
5967Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5968and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 5969@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
5970@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5971@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5972
5973@item ?:
5974The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5975of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5976integral type.
5977
5978@item ||
5979Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5980
5981@item &&
5982Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5983
5984@item |
5985Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5986
5987@item ^
5988Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5989
5990@item &
5991Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5992
5993@item ==@r{, }!=
5994Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5995expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5996
5997@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5998Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5999Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6000and non-zero for true.
6001
6002@item <<@r{, }>>
6003left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6004
6005@item @@
6006The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6007
6008@item +@r{, }-
6009Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6010pointer types.
6011
6012@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6013Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6014defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6015integral types.
6016
6017@item ++@r{, }--
6018Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6019operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6020when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6021operation takes place.
6022
6023@item *
6024Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6025@code{++}.
6026
6027@item &
6028Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6029
c906108c
SS
6030For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6031allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
6032(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
6033where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
6034stored.
c906108c
SS
6035
6036@item -
6037Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6038precedence as @code{++}.
6039
6040@item !
6041Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6042@code{++}.
6043
6044@item ~
6045Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6046@code{++}.
6047
6048
6049@item .@r{, }->
6050Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6051@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6052pointer based on the stored type information.
6053Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6054
c906108c
SS
6055@item .*@r{, }->*
6056Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6057
6058@item []
6059Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6060@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6061
6062@item ()
6063Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6064
c906108c 6065@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6066C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
6067and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6068
6069@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6070Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6071(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6072above.
c906108c
SS
6073@end table
6074
c906108c
SS
6075If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6076attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6077predefined meaning.
c906108c 6078
c906108c 6079@menu
5d161b24 6080* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6081@end menu
6082
6d2ebf8b 6083@node C Constants
c906108c 6084@subsubsection C and C++ constants
c906108c
SS
6085
6086@cindex C and C++ constants
c906108c 6087
7a292a7a 6088@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
c906108c 6089following ways:
c906108c
SS
6090
6091@itemize @bullet
6092@item
6093Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6094specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6095a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6096@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6097@code{long} value.
6098
6099@item
6100Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6101point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6102exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6103@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6104sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6105A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6106@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6107the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6108a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6109constant.
c906108c
SS
6110
6111@item
6112Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6113integral equivalents.
6114
6115@item
6116Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6117(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6118(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6119be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6120the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6121of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6122@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6123@samp{\n} for newline.
6124
6125@item
96a2c332
SS
6126String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6127double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6128above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6129a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6130characters.
c906108c
SS
6131
6132@item
6133Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6134to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6135
6136@item
6137Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6138and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6139integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6140and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6141@end itemize
6142
c906108c 6143@menu
5d161b24
DB
6144* C plus plus expressions::
6145* C Defaults::
6146* C Checks::
c906108c 6147
5d161b24 6148* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6149@end menu
6150
6d2ebf8b 6151@node C plus plus expressions
c906108c 6152@subsubsection C++ expressions
c906108c
SS
6153
6154@cindex expressions in C++
6155@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
6156
c906108c
SS
6157@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
6158@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
6159@cindex C++ and object formats
6160@cindex object formats and C++
6161@cindex a.out and C++
6162@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
6163@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
6164@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
6165@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
6166@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6167@c periodically whether this has happened...
6168@quotation
6169@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
6170proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
6171additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6172special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6173@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6174symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6175you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6176extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
6177@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
6178support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6179@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6180
6181@enumerate
6182
6183@cindex member functions
6184@item
6185Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6186
6187@example
6188count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6189@end example
6190
41afff9a 6191@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
c906108c
SS
6192@cindex namespace in C++
6193@item
6194While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6195expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6196that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6197pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
6198
c906108c 6199@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6200@cindex overloaded functions, calling
c906108c
SS
6201@cindex type conversions in C++
6202@item
6203You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6204call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6205perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6206calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6207in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6208default arguments.
6209
6210It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6211promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6212class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6213functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6214number of function arguments.
6215
6216Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6217@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6218,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6219
d4f3574e 6220You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6221explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6222@smallexample
6223p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6224@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6225
c906108c 6226The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6227see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6228
c906108c
SS
6229@cindex reference declarations
6230@item
5d161b24 6231@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
c906108c
SS
6232them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6233dereferenced.
6234
6235In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6236reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6237avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6238The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6239you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6240
6241@item
6242@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6243expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6244one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6245necessary, for example in an expression like
6246@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6247resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6248debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6249@end enumerate
6250
53a5351d
JM
6251In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6252calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6253objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6254invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 6255
6d2ebf8b 6256@node C Defaults
c906108c 6257@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
7a292a7a 6258
c906108c
SS
6259@cindex C and C++ defaults
6260
c906108c
SS
6261If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6262both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6263C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6264selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
6265
6266If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6267recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6268@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6269these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6270@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6271for further details.
6272
c906108c
SS
6273@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6274@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6275@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 6276
6d2ebf8b 6277@node C Checks
c906108c 6278@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
7a292a7a 6279
c906108c
SS
6280@cindex C and C++ checks
6281
6282By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6283is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6284considers two variables type equivalent if:
6285
6286@itemize @bullet
6287@item
6288The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6289enumerated tag.
6290
6291@item
6292The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6293declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6294
6295@ignore
6296@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6297@c FIXME--beers?
6298@item
6299The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6300declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6301compilers.)
6302@end ignore
6303@end itemize
6304
6305Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6306indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6307that is not itself an array.
c906108c 6308
6d2ebf8b 6309@node Debugging C
c906108c 6310@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
6311
6312The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6313the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
6314inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6315appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
6316
6317The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6318with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6319,Expressions}.
6320
c906108c 6321@menu
5d161b24 6322* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
6323@end menu
6324
6d2ebf8b 6325@node Debugging C plus plus
c906108c 6326@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
c906108c
SS
6327
6328@cindex commands for C++
7a292a7a 6329
c906108c
SS
6330Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6331designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6332
6333@table @code
6334@cindex break in overloaded functions
6335@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6336When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6337@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6338you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6339
6340@cindex overloading in C++
6341@item rbreak @var{regex}
6342Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6343breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6344classes.
6345@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6346
6347@cindex C++ exception handling
6348@item catch throw
6349@itemx catch catch
6350Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6351Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6352
6353@cindex inheritance
6354@item ptype @var{typename}
6355Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6356@var{typename}.
6357@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6358
6359@cindex C++ symbol display
6360@item set print demangle
6361@itemx show print demangle
6362@itemx set print asm-demangle
6363@itemx show print asm-demangle
6364Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6365displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6366@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6367
6368@item set print object
6369@itemx show print object
6370Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6371@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6372
6373@item set print vtbl
6374@itemx show print vtbl
6375Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6376@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c
SS
6377(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6378ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6379
6380@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 6381@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c
SS
6382@item set overload-resolution on
6383Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6384is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6385and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
d4f3574e
SS
6386using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6387expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
6388message.
6389
6390@item set overload-resolution off
6391Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6392overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6393chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6394symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6395overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6396searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6397argument types.
c906108c
SS
6398
6399@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6400You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6401the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6402@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6403also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6404available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6405@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6406@end table
c906108c 6407
6d2ebf8b 6408@node Modula-2
c906108c 6409@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 6410
d4f3574e 6411@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
6412
6413The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6414output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6415developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6416attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6417to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6418table.
6419
6420@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6421@menu
6422* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6423* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6424* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6425* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6426* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6427* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6428* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6429* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6430@end menu
6431
6d2ebf8b 6432@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
6433@subsubsection Operators
6434@cindex Modula-2 operators
6435
6436Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6437@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6438often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6439following definitions hold:
6440
6441@itemize @bullet
6442
6443@item
6444@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6445their subranges.
6446
6447@item
6448@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6449
6450@item
6451@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6452
6453@item
6454@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6455@var{type}}.
6456
6457@item
6458@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6459
6460@item
6461@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6462
6463@item
6464@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6465@end itemize
6466
6467@noindent
6468The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6469increasing precedence:
6470
6471@table @code
6472@item ,
6473Function argument or array index separator.
6474
6475@item :=
6476Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6477@var{value}.
6478
6479@item <@r{, }>
6480Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6481types.
6482
6483@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 6484Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
6485on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6486set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6487
6488@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6489Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6490Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6491available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6492comment character.
6493
6494@item IN
6495Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6496Same precedence as @code{<}.
6497
6498@item OR
6499Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6500
6501@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 6502Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
6503
6504@item @@
6505The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6506
6507@item +@r{, }-
6508Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6509and difference on set types.
6510
6511@item *
6512Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6513on set types.
6514
6515@item /
6516Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6517types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6518
6519@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6520Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6521precedence as @code{*}.
6522
6523@item -
6524Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6525
6526@item ^
6527Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6528
6529@item NOT
6530Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6531@code{^}.
6532
6533@item .
6534@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6535precedence as @code{^}.
6536
6537@item []
6538Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6539
6540@item ()
6541Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6542as @code{^}.
6543
6544@item ::@r{, }.
6545@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6546@end table
6547
6548@quotation
6549@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6550treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6551@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6552@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6553@end quotation
6554
6555@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6d2ebf8b 6556@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
6557@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6558
6559Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6560In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6561
6562@table @var
6563
6564@item a
6565represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6566
6567@item c
6568represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6569
6570@item i
6571represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6572
6573@item m
6574represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6575same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6576be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6577
6578@item n
6579represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6580
6581@item r
6582represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6583
6584@item t
6585represents a type.
6586
6587@item v
6588represents a variable.
6589
6590@item x
6591represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6592explanation of the function for details.
6593@end table
6594
6595All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6596
6597@table @code
6598@item ABS(@var{n})
6599Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6600
6601@item CAP(@var{c})
6602If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 6603equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
6604
6605@item CHR(@var{i})
6606Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6607
6608@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6609Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6610
6611@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6612Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6613new value.
6614
6615@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6616Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6617set.
6618
6619@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6620Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6621
6622@item HIGH(@var{a})
6623Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6624
6625@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6626Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6627
6628@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6629Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6630new value.
6631
6632@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6633Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6634there. Returns the new set.
6635
6636@item MAX(@var{t})
6637Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6638
6639@item MIN(@var{t})
6640Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6641
6642@item ODD(@var{i})
6643Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6644
6645@item ORD(@var{x})
6646Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
6647value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6648@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
6649integral, character and enumerated types.
6650
6651@item SIZE(@var{x})
6652Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6653
6654@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6655Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6656
6657@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6658Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6659@end table
6660
6661@quotation
6662@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6663@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6664an error.
6665@end quotation
6666
6667@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 6668@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
6669@subsubsection Constants
6670
6671@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6672ways:
6673
6674@itemize @bullet
6675
6676@item
6677Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6678expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6679rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6680trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6681
6682@item
6683Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6684decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6685then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6686@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6687digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6688digits.
6689
6690@item
6691Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6692like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 6693also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
6694followed by a @samp{C}.
6695
6696@item
6697String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6698pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6699Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6700Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6701sequences.
6702
6703@item
6704Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6705
6706@item
6707Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6708@code{FALSE}.
6709
6710@item
6711Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6712
6713@item
6714Set constants are not yet supported.
6715@end itemize
6716
6d2ebf8b 6717@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
6718@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6719@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6720
6721If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6722both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 6723Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6724selected the working language.
6725
6726If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6727code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 6728working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
6729the language automatically}, for further details.
6730
6d2ebf8b 6731@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
6732@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6733@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6734
6735A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6736This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6737
6738@itemize @bullet
6739@item
6740Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6741integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6742debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6743pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6744through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6745returned a pointer.)
6746
6747@item
6748C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6749non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6750escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6751printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6752
6753@item
6754The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6755argument.
6756
6757@item
6758All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6759@end itemize
6760
6d2ebf8b 6761@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
6762@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6763@cindex Modula-2 checks
6764
6765@quotation
6766@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6767range checking.
6768@end quotation
6769@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6770
6771@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6772
6773@itemize @bullet
6774@item
6775They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6776@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6777
6778@item
6779They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6780@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6781@end itemize
6782
6783As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6784whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6785
6786Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6787index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6788
6d2ebf8b 6789@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
6790@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6791@cindex scope
41afff9a 6792@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
6793@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6794@ifinfo
41afff9a 6795@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6796@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6797@end ifinfo
6798@iftex
41afff9a 6799@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6800@end iftex
6801
6802There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6803(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6804similar syntax:
6805
6806@example
6807
6808@var{module} . @var{id}
6809@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6810@end example
6811
6812@noindent
6813where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6814@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6815identifier within your program, except another module.
6816
6817Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6818specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6819found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6820enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6821
6822Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6823the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6824definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6825an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6826module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6827@var{module}.
6828
6d2ebf8b 6829@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
6830@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6831
6832Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6833Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6834specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6835@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6836apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6837analogue in Modula-2.
6838
6839The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 6840with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c
SS
6841intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6842created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6843address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 6844@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
6845
6846@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6847In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6848interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 6849
6d2ebf8b 6850@node Chill
cce74817
JM
6851@subsection Chill
6852
6853The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 6854from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
6855supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6856likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6857table.
6858
d4f3574e
SS
6859@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6860@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6861This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
6862of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6863
6864@menu
104c1213
JM
6865* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6866* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 6867* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 6868* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 6869* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
6870@end menu
6871
6d2ebf8b 6872@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
6873@subsubsection How modes are displayed
6874
6875The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 6876with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
6877slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6878provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
6879
6880@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6881@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
6882@table @code
6883@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6884@itemize @bullet
6885@item
6886@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6887UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6888@item
5d161b24 6889@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 6890@item
5d161b24 6891@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
6892@item
6893@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6894@smallexample
6895(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6896type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6897@end smallexample
6898If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6899@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6900@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
6901@smallexample
6902@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
6903@end smallexample
6904where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
6905expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
6906@end itemize
6907
6908@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6909A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 6910the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
6911@smallexample
6912(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6913type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6914@end smallexample
6915
6916@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6917@itemize @bullet
6918@item
d4f3574e 6919@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
6920followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6921@item
6922@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6923@end itemize
6924
6925@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6926The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6927<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
6928list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6929the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
6930all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6931
6932@ignore
6933@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6934The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 6935type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
6936@end ignore
6937
5d161b24 6938@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
6939@itemize @bullet
6940@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6941@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
6942@smallexample
6943@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
6944@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
6945where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6946@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6947@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
6948@smallexample
6949@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
6950@end smallexample
6951where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
6952@end itemize
6953
5d161b24 6954@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
6955@itemize @bullet
6956@item
6957@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6958@item
6959@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6960@end itemize
6961
6962@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6963Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6964
6965@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6966@itemize @bullet
6967@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6968@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
6969@smallexample
6970@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
6971@end smallexample
6972followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
6973mode
cce74817 6974@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6975@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
6976@smallexample
6977@code{BOOLS(<string
6978length>)}
6979@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
6980@end itemize
6981
6982@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6983The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6984followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6985@smallexample
6986(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
6987type = ARRAY (1:42)
6988 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
6989 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6990@end smallexample
6991
5d161b24 6992@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 6993The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
6994list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6995of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6996OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
6997of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6998checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6999always displays all variant fields.
7000@smallexample
7001(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7002type = STRUCT (
7003 as x,
7004 bs x,
7005 CASE bs OF
7006 (karli):
7007 cs a
7008 (ott):
7009 ds x
7010 ESAC
7011)
7012@end smallexample
7013@end table
7014
6d2ebf8b 7015@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7016@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7017
7018A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7019
7020A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7021the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7022Chill programs. How values are specified
7023is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7024
7025The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7026display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7027
cce74817
JM
7028@smallexample
7029set result := EXPR
7030@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7031
7032@noindent
7033This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7034is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7035
7036Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7037value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7038mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7039represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7040value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7041operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7042
6d2ebf8b
SS
7043Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7044@smallexample
7045@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7046(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7047location>}
7048@end smallexample
7049@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7050specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7051the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7052
7053@ignore
7054Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7055fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7056the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7057implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7058na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7059<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7060@code{__proc_copy}.
7061
7062Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7063the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7064like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7065mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7066
7067Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7068...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7069definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7070of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7071structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7072braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7073on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7074memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7075all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7076@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7077stuff ???)
7078@smallexample
7079(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7080[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7081@end smallexample
7082@end ignore
7083
7084Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7085(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7086certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7087and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7088
7089A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7090location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7091name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7092have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7093checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7094therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7095
cce74817
JM
7096@smallexample
7097(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7098@end smallexample
7099
6d2ebf8b 7100@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7101@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7102
7103Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7104more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7105data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7106such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7107constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7108when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7109(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7110the values behind these locations.
7111
d4f3574e 7112This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7113operations are legal to be used with such values.
7114
7115@table @code
7116@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7117Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7118For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7119chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7120@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7121@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7122
5d161b24 7123@ignore
cce74817
JM
7124@itemize @bullet
7125@item
7126@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7127programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7128@item
7129@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7130@item
7131@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7132@code{'M'})
7133@item
7134@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e
SS
7135mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
7136comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
cce74817 7137@item
d4f3574e 7138@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7139emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7140procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7141
7142@item
7143@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7144enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7145to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7146@item
7147@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7148programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7149@item
7150@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7151(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7152@end itemize
7153@end ignore
7154
7155@item Tuple Values
7156A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7157name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7158unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7159@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7160
cce74817
JM
7161@itemize @bullet
7162@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7163@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7164@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7165Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7166same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7167@end itemize
7168
7169@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7170A string element value is specified by
7171@smallexample
7172@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7173@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7174where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7175value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7176the string.
7177
7178@item String Slice Value
7179A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7180spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7181expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7182@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7183The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7184string.
7185
7186@item Array Element Values
7187An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7188delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7189
7190@item Array Slice Values
7191An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7192@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7193@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7194arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7195which is part of the specified array.
7196
7197@item Structure Field Values
7198A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7199name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7200in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7201corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7202
7203@item Procedure Call Value
7204The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7205procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7206expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7207effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7208
d4f3574e 7209Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7210
6d2ebf8b
SS
7211Values of time mode locations appear as
7212@smallexample
7213@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7214@end smallexample
7215
cce74817
JM
7216
7217@ignore
7218This is not implemented yet:
7219@item Built-in Value
7220@noindent
7221The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7222
cce74817
JM
7223@table @code
7224@item @code{ADDR()}
7225@item @code{NUM()}
7226@item @code{PRED()}
7227@item @code{SUCC()}
7228@item @code{ABS()}
7229@item @code{CARD()}
7230@item @code{MAX()}
7231@item @code{MIN()}
7232@item @code{SIZE()}
7233@item @code{UPPER()}
7234@item @code{LOWER()}
7235@item @code{LENGTH()}
7236@item @code{SIN()}
7237@item @code{COS()}
7238@item @code{TAN()}
7239@item @code{ARCSIN()}
7240@item @code{ARCCOS()}
7241@item @code{ARCTAN()}
7242@item @code{EXP()}
7243@item @code{LN()}
7244@item @code{LOG()}
7245@item @code{SQRT()}
7246@end table
7247
7248For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7249chapter 1.6.
7250@end ignore
7251
7252@item Zero-adic Operator Value
7253The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7254current active process.
7255
7256@item Expression Values
7257The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 7258the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 7259incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 7260corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 7261causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 7262which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 7263operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 7264
cce74817
JM
7265@table @code
7266@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7267@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7268@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7269Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 7270
cce74817
JM
7271@item @code{=, /=}
7272Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 7273
cce74817 7274@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7275@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7276Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7277
cce74817 7278@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 7279@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 7280Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7281
cce74817
JM
7282@item @code{-}
7283Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 7284
cce74817
JM
7285@item @code{//}
7286String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 7287
cce74817
JM
7288@item @code{()}
7289String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 7290
cce74817
JM
7291@item @code{->}
7292Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7293address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7294location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 7295
cce74817 7296@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7297@itemx @code{AND}
7298@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7299Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 7300
cce74817 7301@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7302@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7303Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 7304
cce74817
JM
7305@item @code{IN}
7306Membership operator.
7307@end table
7308@end table
7309
6d2ebf8b 7310@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
7311@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7312
7313@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 7314of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 7315complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 7316equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
7317structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7318
7319Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7320index bounds and all built in procedures.
7321
7322Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 7323check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
7324operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7325functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7326language specification.
7327
cce74817
JM
7328All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7329off}.
7330
5d161b24 7331@ignore
53a5351d 7332@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
7333see last paragraph ?
7334@end ignore
7335
6d2ebf8b 7336@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
7337@subsubsection Chill defaults
7338
7339If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7340both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7341Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
7342selected the working language.
7343
7344If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7345code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 7346working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
7347the language automatically}, for further details.
7348
6d2ebf8b 7349@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
7350@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7351
d4f3574e 7352The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
7353symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7354program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7355does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7356program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7357(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7358file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7359
7360@cindex symbol names
7361@cindex names of symbols
7362@cindex quoting names
7363Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7364characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7365most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7366source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7367are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7368ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7369@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7370@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7371
7372@example
7373p 'foo.c'::x
7374@end example
7375
7376@noindent
7377looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7378
7379@table @code
7380@kindex info address
7381@item info address @var{symbol}
7382Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7383variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7384local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7385is always stored.
7386
7387Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7388at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7389the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7390
7391@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
7392@item whatis @var{expr}
7393Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
7394actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7395assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7396@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7397
7398@item whatis
7399Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7400
7401@kindex ptype
7402@item ptype @var{typename}
7403Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
7404the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7405@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7406@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 7407
d4f3574e 7408@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 7409@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 7410Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
7411differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7412of just the name of the type.
7413
7414For example, for this variable declaration:
7415
7416@example
7417struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7418@end example
7419
7420@noindent
7421the two commands give this output:
7422
7423@example
7424@group
7425(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7426type = struct complex
7427(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7428type = struct complex @{
7429 double real;
7430 double imag;
7431@}
7432@end group
7433@end example
7434
7435@noindent
7436As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7437the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7438
7439@kindex info types
7440@item info types @var{regexp}
7441@itemx info types
d4f3574e 7442Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
7443(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7444complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7445@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 7446names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
7447information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7448
7449This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7450@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7451lists all source files where a type is defined.
7452
7453@kindex info source
7454@item info source
7455Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7456the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7457it was written in.
7458
7459@kindex info sources
7460@item info sources
7461Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7462debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7463have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7464
7465@kindex info functions
7466@item info functions
7467Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7468
7469@item info functions @var{regexp}
7470Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7471whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7472Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7473include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7474start with @code{step}.
7475
7476@kindex info variables
7477@item info variables
7478Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7479outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7480
7481@item info variables @var{regexp}
7482Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7483variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7484@var{regexp}.
7485
7486@ignore
7487This was never implemented.
7488@kindex info methods
7489@item info methods
7490@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7491The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7492methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7493specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7494C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7495from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7496@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7497which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7498@end ignore
7499
c906108c
SS
7500@cindex reloading symbols
7501Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
7502be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7503in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7504running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7505@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
7506
7507@table @code
7508@kindex set symbol-reloading
7509@item set symbol-reloading on
7510Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7511object file with a particular name is seen again.
7512
7513@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
7514Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
7515same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
7516running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
7517should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
7518may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
7519several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
7520name.
c906108c
SS
7521
7522@kindex show symbol-reloading
7523@item show symbol-reloading
7524Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7525@end table
c906108c 7526
c906108c
SS
7527@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7528@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7529Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7530declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7531@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7532source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7533another source file. The default is on.
7534
7535A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7536the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7537
7538@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7539Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7540is printed as follows:
7541@smallexample
7542@{<no data fields>@}
7543@end smallexample
7544
7545@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7546@item show opaque-type-resolution
7547Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
7548
7549@kindex maint print symbols
7550@cindex symbol dump
7551@kindex maint print psymbols
7552@cindex partial symbol dump
7553@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7554@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7555@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7556Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7557These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7558symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7559symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7560collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7561only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7562command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7563use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7564symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7565files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7566@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7567required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7568@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7569@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7570@end table
7571
6d2ebf8b 7572@node Altering
c906108c
SS
7573@chapter Altering Execution
7574
7575Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7576find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7577correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7578experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7579program.
7580
7581For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
7582locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7583address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
7584
7585@menu
7586* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7587* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 7588* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
7589* Returning:: Returning from a function
7590* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7591* Patching:: Patching your program
7592@end menu
7593
6d2ebf8b 7594@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
7595@section Assignment to variables
7596
7597@cindex assignment
7598@cindex setting variables
7599To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7600@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7601
7602@example
7603print x=4
7604@end example
7605
7606@noindent
7607stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 7608value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
7609@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7610information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
7611
7612@kindex set variable
7613@cindex variables, setting
7614If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7615@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7616really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7617not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7618,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7619
c906108c
SS
7620If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7621appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7622variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7623to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7624program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7625a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7626command @code{set width}:
7627
7628@example
7629(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7630type = double
7631(@value{GDBP}) p width
7632$4 = 13
7633(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7634Invalid syntax in expression.
7635@end example
7636
7637@noindent
7638The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7639order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7640
7641@example
7642(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7643@end example
53a5351d 7644
c906108c
SS
7645Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7646with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7647@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7648your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7649to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7650the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7651
7652@example
7653@group
7654(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7655type = double
7656(@value{GDBP}) p g
7657$1 = 1
7658(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 7659(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
7660$2 = 1
7661(@value{GDBP}) r
7662The program being debugged has been started already.
7663Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7664Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
7665"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
7666 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
7667(@value{GDBP}) show g
7668The current BFD target is "=4".
7669@end group
7670@end example
7671
7672@noindent
7673The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7674@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7675@code{g}, use
7676
7677@example
7678(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7679@end example
c906108c
SS
7680
7681@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7682freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7683and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7684same length or shorter.
7685@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7686@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7687
7688To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7689construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7690(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7691to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7692and representation in memory), and
7693
7694@example
7695set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7696@end example
7697
7698@noindent
7699stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7700
6d2ebf8b 7701@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
7702@section Continuing at a different address
7703
7704Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7705it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7706an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7707
7708@table @code
7709@kindex jump
7710@item jump @var{linespec}
7711Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7712immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7713source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7714@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7715in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7716breakpoints}.
7717
7718The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7719the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7720register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7721a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7722be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7723of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7724confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7725executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7726well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7727
7728@item jump *@var{address}
7729Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7730@end table
7731
c906108c 7732@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
7733On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7734command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7735difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7736changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7737example,
c906108c
SS
7738
7739@example
7740set $pc = 0x485
7741@end example
7742
7743@noindent
7744makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7745address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7746@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
7747
7748The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7749up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7750that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7751detail.
7752
c906108c 7753@c @group
6d2ebf8b 7754@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
7755@section Giving your program a signal
7756
7757@table @code
7758@kindex signal
7759@item signal @var{signal}
7760Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7761signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7762signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7763SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7764
7765Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7766giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7767a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7768@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7769signal.
7770
7771@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7772after executing the command.
7773@end table
7774@c @end group
7775
7776Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7777@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7778causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7779the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7780passes the signal directly to your program.
7781
c906108c 7782
6d2ebf8b 7783@node Returning
c906108c
SS
7784@section Returning from a function
7785
7786@table @code
7787@cindex returning from a function
7788@kindex return
7789@item return
7790@itemx return @var{expression}
7791You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7792command. If you give an
7793@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7794value.
7795@end table
7796
7797When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7798(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7799discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7800be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7801
7802This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7803frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7804innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7805specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7806of functions.
7807
7808The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7809program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7810returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7811and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7812selected stack frame returns naturally.
7813
6d2ebf8b 7814@node Calling
c906108c
SS
7815@section Calling program functions
7816
7817@cindex calling functions
7818@kindex call
7819@table @code
7820@item call @var{expr}
7821Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7822returned values.
7823@end table
7824
7825You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7826execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
7827with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7828is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 7829
c906108c
SS
7830For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7831specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7832calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7833method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7834that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 7835
6d2ebf8b 7836@node Patching
c906108c 7837@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 7838
c906108c
SS
7839@cindex patching binaries
7840@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 7841@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 7842
7a292a7a
SS
7843By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7844executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7845alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7846patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
7847
7848If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7849explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7850want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7851repairs.
7852
7853@table @code
7854@kindex set write
7855@item set write on
7856@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
7857If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7858core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
7859off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7860
7861If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
7862@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7863write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
7864
7865@item show write
7866@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
7867Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7868as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
7869@end table
7870
6d2ebf8b 7871@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
7872@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7873
7a292a7a
SS
7874@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7875both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7876program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7877@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
7878
7879@menu
7880* Files:: Commands to specify files
7881* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7882@end menu
7883
6d2ebf8b 7884@node Files
c906108c 7885@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 7886
7a292a7a 7887@cindex symbol table
c906108c 7888@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
7889
7890You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7891way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7892@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7893Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
7894
7895Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7896@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7897a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7898to specify new files are useful.
7899
7900@table @code
7901@cindex executable file
7902@kindex file
7903@item file @var{filename}
7904Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7905symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7906executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
7907directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7908@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7909directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7910to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7911and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7912
6d2ebf8b 7913On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
7914@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7915@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7916@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7917descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7918(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 7919@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 7920for more information.
c906108c
SS
7921
7922@item file
7923@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7924has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7925
7926@kindex exec-file
7927@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7928Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7929in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7930if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7931discard information on the executable file.
7932
7933@kindex symbol-file
7934@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7935Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7936searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7937table and program to run from the same file.
7938
7939@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7940program's symbol table.
7941
5d161b24 7942The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
7943of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7944auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7945the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7946the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7947
7948@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7949executing it once.
7950
7951When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7952understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7953generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7954other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
7955Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7956using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7957optimized code.
c906108c
SS
7958
7959For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7960using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7961symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7962quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7963details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7964
7965The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7966start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7967occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7968file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7969pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7970warnings and messages}.)
7971
c906108c
SS
7972We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7973symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7974symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7975still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7976in stabs format.
7977
7978@kindex readnow
7979@cindex reading symbols immediately
7980@cindex symbols, reading immediately
7981@kindex mapped
7982@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7983@cindex saving symbol table
7984@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7985@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7986You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7987tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7988load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 7989entire symbol table available.
c906108c 7990
c906108c
SS
7991If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7992@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7993cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7994file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7995from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7996than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7997program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7998starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7999
8000You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8001file has all the symbol information for your program.
8002
8003The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8004@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8005than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8006it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8007needed.
8008
8009The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8010@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8011symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8012
8013@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8014@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8015@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8016@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8017@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8018@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8019@c files.
8020
8021@kindex core
8022@kindex core-file
8023@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8024Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8025of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8026address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8027executable file itself for other parts.
8028
8029@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8030to be used.
8031
8032Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8033under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8034wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8035the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8036(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8037
c906108c
SS
8038@kindex add-symbol-file
8039@cindex dynamic linking
8040@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8041@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
d167840f 8042@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
8043The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8044information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8045when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8046into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8047address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8048this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8049of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8050section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8051@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8052
8053The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8054originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8055@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8056thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8057instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
8058
8059@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8060
8061You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8062the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8063table information for @var{filename}.
8064
8065@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8066@item add-shared-symbol-file
8067The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8068operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8069shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8070@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8071
c906108c
SS
8072@kindex section
8073@item section
5d161b24
DB
8074The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8075the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8076section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8077specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8078separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8079the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8080
8081@kindex info files
8082@kindex info target
8083@item info files
8084@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8085@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8086current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8087including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8088use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8089command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8090current ones.
8091
c906108c
SS
8092@end table
8093
8094All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8095as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8096name and remembers it that way.
8097
c906108c 8098@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8099@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8100libraries.
53a5351d 8101
c906108c
SS
8102@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8103when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8104(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8105references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8106debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8107
8108On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8109automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8110
c906108c
SS
8111@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8112@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8113@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8114
8115@table @code
8116@kindex info sharedlibrary
8117@kindex info share
8118@item info share
8119@itemx info sharedlibrary
8120Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8121
8122@kindex sharedlibrary
8123@kindex share
8124@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8125@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8126Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8127Unix regular expression.
8128As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8129required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8130@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8131loaded.
8132@end table
8133
53a5351d
JM
8134On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8135and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8136a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8137
8138Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8139loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8140@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8141automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8142
8143To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8144
8145@table @code
8146@kindex set auto-solib-add
8147@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8148Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8149nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8150automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8151linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8152the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8153Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8154@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8155
8156@kindex show auto-solib-add
8157@item show auto-solib-add
8158Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8159@end table
c906108c 8160
6d2ebf8b 8161@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8162@section Errors reading symbol files
8163
8164While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8165such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8166output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8167they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8168debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8169about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8170only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8171times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8172to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8173complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8174messages}).
8175
8176The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8177
8178@table @code
8179@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8180
8181The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8182(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8183error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8184in its outer scope blocks.
8185
8186@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8187the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8188may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8189function.
8190
8191@item block at @var{address} out of order
8192
8193The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8194order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8195do so.
8196
8197@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8198locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
8199can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8200@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8201messages}.)
8202
8203@item bad block start address patched
8204
8205The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
8206smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
8207to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
8208
8209@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
8210starting on the previous source line.
8211
8212@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
8213
8214@cindex foo
8215Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
8216larger than the size of the string table.
8217
8218@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
8219name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
8220with this name.
8221
8222@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
8223
7a292a7a
SS
8224The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
8225not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 8226uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 8227
7a292a7a
SS
8228@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
8229This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 8230are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
8231debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
8232on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
8233and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
8234
8235@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 8236
7a292a7a 8237@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 8238
7a292a7a 8239@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
c906108c 8240The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
8241information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
8242it.
c906108c
SS
8243
8244@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8245
8246@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 8247
c906108c
SS
8248@end table
8249
6d2ebf8b 8250@node Targets
c906108c 8251@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 8252
c906108c
SS
8253@cindex debugging target
8254@kindex target
8255
8256A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
8257
8258Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8259in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8260you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
8261flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8262host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
8263realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8264command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8265(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
8266
8267@menu
8268* Active Targets:: Active targets
8269* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
8270* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8271* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 8272* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
8273
8274@end menu
8275
6d2ebf8b 8276@node Active Targets
c906108c 8277@section Active targets
7a292a7a 8278
c906108c
SS
8279@cindex stacking targets
8280@cindex active targets
8281@cindex multiple targets
8282
c906108c 8283There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
8284executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8285active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8286start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8287a core file.
c906108c
SS
8288
8289For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8290@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8291well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8292@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8293first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8294requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8295are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8296read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8297executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
8298
8299When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
8300target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8301commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8302an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8303process target is active.
c906108c 8304
7a292a7a
SS
8305Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8306core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 8307files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
8308the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8309process}).
c906108c 8310
6d2ebf8b 8311@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
8312@section Commands for managing targets
8313
8314@table @code
8315@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
8316Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8317process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8318facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8319protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
8320
8321Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8322typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8323with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
8324
8325The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8326after executing the command.
8327
8328@kindex help target
8329@item help target
8330Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8331currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8332(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8333
8334@item help target @var{name}
8335Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8336select it.
8337
8338@kindex set gnutarget
8339@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 8340@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8341knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
8342a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8343with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
8344with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8345
d4f3574e 8346@quotation
c906108c
SS
8347@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8348you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 8349@end quotation
c906108c 8350
d4f3574e
SS
8351@noindent
8352@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 8353
5d161b24 8354@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
8355@item show gnutarget
8356Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8357@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8358@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8359and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8360@end table
8361
c906108c
SS
8362Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8363configuration):
c906108c
SS
8364
8365@table @code
8366@kindex target exec
8367@item target exec @var{program}
8368An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8369@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8370
c906108c
SS
8371@kindex target core
8372@item target core @var{filename}
8373A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8374@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
8375
8376@kindex target remote
8377@item target remote @var{dev}
8378Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8379specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8380@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8381supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
8382some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8383it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8384
c906108c
SS
8385@kindex target sim
8386@item target sim
2df3850c 8387Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
8388In general,
8389@example
8390 target sim
8391 load
8392 run
8393@end example
d4f3574e 8394@noindent
104c1213 8395works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 8396drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
8397provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8398see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8399Processors}.
8400
c906108c
SS
8401@end table
8402
104c1213 8403Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
8404
8405@table @code
8406
c906108c
SS
8407@kindex target nrom
8408@item target nrom @var{dev}
8409NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8410
c906108c
SS
8411@end table
8412
5d161b24 8413Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 8414your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
8415
8416Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8417once you've successfully established a connection.
8418
8419@table @code
8420
8421@kindex load @var{filename}
8422@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
8423Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8424@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8425is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8426on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8427@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8428the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8429
8430If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8431execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8432target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
8433
8434The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8435For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8436link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8437specifies a fixed address.
8438@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8439
c906108c
SS
8440@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8441@end table
8442
6d2ebf8b 8443@node Byte Order
c906108c 8444@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 8445
c906108c
SS
8446@cindex choosing target byte order
8447@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
8448
8449Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8450offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8451orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8452designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8453which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 8454@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
8455
8456@table @code
8457@kindex set endian big
8458@item set endian big
8459Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8460
8461@kindex set endian little
8462@item set endian little
8463Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8464
8465@kindex set endian auto
8466@item set endian auto
8467Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8468executable.
8469
8470@item show endian
8471Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8472
8473@end table
8474
8475Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8476data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8477target system.
8478
6d2ebf8b 8479@node Remote
c906108c
SS
8480@section Remote debugging
8481@cindex remote debugging
8482
8483If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
8484@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8485For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
8486or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8487powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8488
8489Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8490to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 8491@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
8492but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8493write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8494communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8495
8496Other remote targets may be available in your
8497configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 8498
c906108c 8499@menu
c906108c 8500* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
8501@end menu
8502
6d2ebf8b 8503@node Remote Serial
104c1213 8504@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 8505
104c1213
JM
8506@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8507To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8508@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8509prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8510program, you need:
c906108c 8511
104c1213
JM
8512@enumerate
8513@item
8514A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8515have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8516your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 8517
5d161b24 8518@item
d4f3574e 8519A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 8520subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 8521
104c1213
JM
8522@item
8523A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8524download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8525manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8526documentation.
8527@end enumerate
96baa820 8528
104c1213
JM
8529The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8530communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8531machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 8532
104c1213
JM
8533@table @emph
8534@item On the host,
8535@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8536else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8537(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8538
8539@item On the target,
8540you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8541implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8542subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8543
8544On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8545@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8546@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8547@end table
96baa820 8548
104c1213
JM
8549The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8550machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8551@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 8552
104c1213
JM
8553@cindex remote serial stub list
8554These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 8555
104c1213
JM
8556@table @code
8557
8558@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 8559@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8560@cindex Intel
8561@cindex i386
8562For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8563
8564@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 8565@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8566@cindex Motorola 680x0
8567@cindex m680x0
8568For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8569
8570@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 8571@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8572@cindex Hitachi
8573@cindex SH
8574For Hitachi SH architectures.
8575
8576@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 8577@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8578@cindex Sparc
8579For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8580
8581@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 8582@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8583@cindex Fujitsu
8584@cindex SparcLite
8585For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8586
8587@end table
8588
8589The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8590recently added stubs.
8591
8592@menu
8593* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8594* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8595* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8596* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8597* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8598* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8599@end menu
8600
6d2ebf8b 8601@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
8602@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8603
8604@cindex remote serial stub
8605The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8606subroutines:
8607
8608@table @code
8609@item set_debug_traps
8610@kindex set_debug_traps
8611@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8612This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8613program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8614beginning of your program.
8615
8616@item handle_exception
8617@kindex handle_exception
8618@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8619This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8620explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8621run when a trap is triggered.
8622
8623@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8624execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8625with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8626protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 8627representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
8628information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8629retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8630execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8631@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 8632machine.
104c1213
JM
8633
8634@item breakpoint
8635@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8636Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8637breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8638way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8639machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8640pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8641@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8642simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8643again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8644your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 8645@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
8646
8647Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8648to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8649start of your debugging session.
8650@end table
8651
6d2ebf8b 8652@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
8653@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8654
8655@cindex remote stub, support routines
8656The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8657chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8658debugging target machine.
8659
8660First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8661serial port.
8662
8663@table @code
8664@item int getDebugChar()
8665@kindex getDebugChar
8666Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8667It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8668different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8669
8670@item void putDebugChar(int)
8671@kindex putDebugChar
8672Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 8673It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
8674different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8675@end table
8676
8677@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8678@cindex interrupting remote targets
8679If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8680running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8681for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8682character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8683remote system to stop.
8684
8685Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8686probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8687is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8688@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8689
8690Other routines you need to supply are:
8691
8692@table @code
8693@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8694@kindex exceptionHandler
8695Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8696handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8697way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8698are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8699containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8700@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8701its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8702might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8703exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8704@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8705and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8706you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8707should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8708
8709For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8710gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8711should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8712@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8713help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8714
8715@item void flush_i_cache()
8716@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 8717On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
8718instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8719instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8720
8721On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8722function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8723@end table
8724
8725@noindent
8726You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8727
8728@table @code
8729@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8730@kindex memset
8731This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8732memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8733@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8734either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8735@end table
8736
8737If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8738library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8739but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 8740subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
8741
8742
6d2ebf8b 8743@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
8744@subsubsection Putting it all together
8745
8746@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8747In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8748steps.
8749
8750@enumerate
8751@item
6d2ebf8b 8752Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
8753(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8754@display
8755@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8756@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8757@end display
8758
8759@item
8760Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8761
8762@example
8763set_debug_traps();
8764breakpoint();
8765@end example
8766
8767@item
8768For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8769@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8770
8771@example
8772void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8773@end example
8774
d4f3574e 8775@noindent
104c1213 8776but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 8777function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
8778@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8779error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8780one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8781
8782@item
8783Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8784your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8785
8786@item
8787Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8788the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8789
8790@item
8791@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8792@c document that. FIXME.
8793Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8794whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8795
8796@item
8797To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8798as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8799This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8800of its pure text.
8801
d4f3574e 8802@item
104c1213 8803@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8804Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
8805Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8806machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8807TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8808to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8809device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8810
8811@example
8812target remote /dev/ttyb
8813@end example
8814
8815@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8816To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8817@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8818terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8819
8820@example
8821target remote manyfarms:2828
8822@end example
8823@end enumerate
8824
8825Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8826step and continue the remote program.
8827
8828To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8829command.
8830
8831@cindex interrupting remote programs
8832@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8833Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8834interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8835program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8836and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8837interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8838
8839@example
8840Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8841Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8842@end example
8843
8844If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8845(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8846remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8847goes back to waiting.
8848
6d2ebf8b 8849@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
8850@subsubsection Communication protocol
8851
8852@cindex debugging stub, example
8853@cindex remote stub, example
8854@cindex stub example, remote debugging
8855The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8856communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8857@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8858these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8859implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8860with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8861organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8862
8863However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8864the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8865target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8866it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8867
8868In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8869transmitted and received data respectfully.
8870
8871@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8872@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8873@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
8874All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
8875sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
8876@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
8877@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
8878
8879@example
8880@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8881@end example
8882@noindent
104c1213
JM
8883
8884@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8885@noindent
8886The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
8887characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
8888eight bit unsigned checksum).
8889
8890Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
8891specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
8892
8893@example
8894@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8895@end example
104c1213
JM
8896
8897@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8898@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
8899That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
8900has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
8901since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 8902
6cf7e474 8903@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
8904When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8905response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8906the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8907retransmission):
8908
8909@example
8910<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8911-> @code{+}
8912@end example
8913@noindent
104c1213
JM
8914
8915The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8916debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8917the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8918when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8919
8920@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
8921exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
8922exceptions).
8923
8924Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
8925@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
8926HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
8927
8928Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
8929@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
8930would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
8931
8932Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 8933means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
8934which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8935@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
8936where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
8937characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8938value greater than 126 should not be used.
8939
8940Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8941loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
8942character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
8943
8944So:
8945@example
8946"@code{0* }"
8947@end example
8948@noindent
8949means the same as "0000".
8950
598ca718 8951The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
8952error number. That number is not well defined.
8953
8954For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8955(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8956protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 8957on that response.
104c1213 8958
f1251bdd
C
8959A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
8960@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
8961optional.
8962
104c1213
JM
8963Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8964their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 8965@page
104c1213
JM
8966@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8967@item Packet
8968@tab Request
8969@tab Description
8970
f1251bdd 8971@item extended ops
104c1213
JM
8972@tab @code{!}
8973@tab
d4f3574e 8974Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
598ca718 8975The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
104c1213
JM
8976@item
8977@tab reply @samp{}
8978@tab
8979Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8980unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8981support protocol extensions.
8982
8983@item last signal
8984@tab @code{?}
8985@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8986Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
8987and continue.
8988@item
8989@tab reply
8990@tab see below
8991
104c1213
JM
8992
8993@item reserved
8994@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 8995@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 8996
f1251bdd 8997@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
8998@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8999@tab
598ca718
EZ
9000@item
9001@tab
9002@tab
104c1213
JM
9003Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9004specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9005See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9006@item
9007@tab reply @code{OK}
9008@item
9009@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9010
9011@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9012@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9013@tab
9014Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9015transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9016transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9017acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9018to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9019ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9020specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9021that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9022happened.}
9023
9024@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9025@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9026@tab
9027Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9028breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9029@samp{z} packets.}
9030
9031@item continue
9032@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9033@tab
9034@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9035current address.
9036@item
9037@tab reply
9038@tab see below
9039
f1251bdd 9040@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9041@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9042@tab
9043Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9044@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9045@item
9046@tab reply
9047@tab see below
9048
598ca718 9049@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9050@tab @code{d}
9051@tab
d4f3574e 9052toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9053
f1251bdd 9054@item detach
104c1213 9055@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9056@tab
2df3850c
JM
9057Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9058@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9059@item
9060@tab reply @emph{no response}
9061@tab
598ca718 9062@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9063
9064@item reserved
9065@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9066@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9067
9068@item reserved
9069@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9070@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9071
9072@item reserved
9073@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9074@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9075
9076@item reserved
9077@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9078@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9079
9080@item read registers
9081@tab @code{g}
9082@tab Read general registers.
9083@item
9084@tab reply @var{XX...}
9085@tab
9086Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9087with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9088each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9089determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9090@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9091@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9092@item
9093@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9094@tab for an error.
9095
9096@item write regs
9097@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9098@tab
9099See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9100@item
9101@tab reply @code{OK}
9102@tab for success
9103@item
9104@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9105@tab for an error
9106
9107@item reserved
9108@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 9109@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9110
f1251bdd 9111@item set thread
104c1213
JM
9112@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9113@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9114Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9115@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9116continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9117thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9118@item
9119@tab reply @code{OK}
9120@tab for success
9121@item
9122@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9123@tab for an error
9124
d4f3574e
SS
9125@c FIXME: JTC:
9126@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 9127@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
9128@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9129@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9130@c described. For example:
9131@c
9132@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9133@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9134@c otherwise returns current registers.
9135@c
9136@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9137@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9138@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9139
f1251bdd 9140@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9141@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9142@tab
9143Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9144present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9145step starting at that address.
9146
f1251bdd 9147@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9148@tab @code{I}
9149@tab
9150See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9151
9152@item reserved
9153@tab @code{j}
9154@tab Reserved for future use
9155
9156@item reserved
9157@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 9158@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9159
f1251bdd 9160@item kill request
104c1213
JM
9161@tab @code{k}
9162@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9163FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9164thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9165
9166@item reserved
9167@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 9168@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9169
9170@item reserved
9171@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 9172@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9173
9174@item read memory
9175@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9176@tab
9177Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9178Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9179using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9180transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9181@item
9182@tab reply @var{XX...}
9183@tab
d4f3574e 9184@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9185to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9186sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9187@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9188@item
9189@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9190@tab @var{NN} is errno
9191
9192@item write mem
9193@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9194@tab
9195Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9196@var{XX...} is the data.
9197@item
9198@tab reply @code{OK}
9199@tab for success
9200@item
9201@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9202@tab
9203for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
9204written).
9205
9206@item reserved
9207@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 9208@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9209
9210@item reserved
9211@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 9212@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9213
9214@item reserved
9215@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 9216@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9217
9218@item reserved
9219@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 9220@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9221
9222@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
9223@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
9224@tab
9225See write register.
9226@item
9227@tab return @var{r....}
9228@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
9229
f1251bdd 9230@item write reg
104c1213
JM
9231@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
9232@tab
9233Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
9234digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
9235@item
9236@tab reply @code{OK}
9237@tab for success
9238@item
9239@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9240@tab for an error
9241
f1251bdd 9242@item general query
104c1213
JM
9243@tab @code{q}@var{query}
9244@tab
598ca718 9245Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 9246have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
9247company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
9248optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
9249must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
9250@item
9251@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 9252@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
9253@item
9254@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9255@tab error reply
9256@item
9257@tab reply @samp{}
9258@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9259
f1251bdd 9260@item general set
104c1213
JM
9261@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9262@tab
9263Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9264naming conventions.
9265
598ca718 9266@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
9267@tab @code{r}
9268@tab
9269Reset the entire system.
104c1213 9270
f1251bdd 9271@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
9272@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9273@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9274Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9275definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9276packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213 9277
f1251bdd 9278@item step
104c1213
JM
9279@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9280@tab
9281@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9282same address.
9283@item
9284@tab reply
9285@tab see below
9286
f1251bdd 9287@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
9288@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9289@tab
9290Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9291@item
9292@tab reply
9293@tab see below
9294
f1251bdd 9295@item search
104c1213
JM
9296@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9297@tab
9298Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9299@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 9300bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 9301
f1251bdd 9302@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
9303@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9304@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9305@item
9306@tab reply @code{OK}
9307@tab thread is still alive
9308@item
9309@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9310@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 9311
104c1213
JM
9312@item reserved
9313@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 9314@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9315
9316@item reserved
9317@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 9318@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9319
9320@item reserved
9321@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 9322@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9323
9324@item reserved
9325@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 9326@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9327
9328@item reserved
9329@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 9330@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9331
9332@item reserved
9333@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 9334@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9335
9336@item reserved
9337@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 9338@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9339
f1251bdd 9340@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
9341@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9342@tab
9343@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
9344binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9345escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
9346@item
9347@tab reply @code{OK}
9348@tab for success
9349@item
9350@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9351@tab for an error
9352
9353@item reserved
9354@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 9355@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9356
9357@item reserved
9358@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 9359@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9360
f1251bdd 9361@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9362@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9363@tab
9364See @samp{Z}.
9365
f1251bdd 9366@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9367@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9368@tab
9369@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9370breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9371@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9372bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9373the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
9374@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9375potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 9376implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
9377@item
9378@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9379@tab for an error
9380@item
9381@tab reply @code{OK}
9382@tab for success
9383@item
9384@tab @samp{}
9385@tab If not supported.
9386
9387@item reserved
9388@tab <other>
5d161b24 9389@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9390
9391@end multitable
9392
d4f3574e
SS
9393The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9394receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9395@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9396when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9397number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9398conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
9399
9400@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9401
9402@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9403@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9404
9405@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9406@tab
9407@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9408(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9409by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9410thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 9411starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
9412@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9413extend the protocol.
9414
9415@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9416@tab
9417The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9418applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9419
9420@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9421@tab
9422The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9423
6d2ebf8b 9424@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 9425@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
9426@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
9427@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
9428@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
9429this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
9430spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
9431debugger.}
104c1213
JM
9432
9433@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9434@tab
c3f6f71d 9435@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
9436while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9437for 'W', 'T', etc.
9438
9439@end multitable
9440
d4f3574e
SS
9441The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9442
9443@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9444
9445@item current thread
9446@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9447@tab Return the current thread id.
9448@item
9449@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9450@tab
9451Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9452@item
9453@tab reply *
9454@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9455
bba2971c
MS
9456@item all thread ids
9457@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9458@item
9459@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 9460@tab
bba2971c
MS
9461Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
9462may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
9463works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
9464obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 9465be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 9466sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 9467@item
bba2971c
MS
9468@tab
9469@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 9470@item
5d161b24 9471@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
9472@tab A single thread id
9473@item
00e4a2e4 9474@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
9475@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
9476@item
9477@tab reply @code{l}
9478@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
9479@item
9480@tab
9481@tab
9482In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
9483or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
9484respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
9485@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
9486(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
9487
9488@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 9489@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
9490@tab
9491@item
9492@tab
9493@tab
9494Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
9495Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
9496the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
9497thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
9498The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 9499Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
9500"Blocked on Mutex".
9501@item
9502@tab reply @var{XX...}
9503@tab
9504Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
9505printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
9506attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
9507
9508@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9509@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9510@tab
2b628194
MS
9511@item
9512@tab
9513@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9514Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9515digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9516subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9517number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9518(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9519returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9520@item
bba2971c
MS
9521@tab
9522@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9523query (see above).
9524@item
d4f3574e
SS
9525@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9526@tab
2b628194
MS
9527@item
9528@tab
9529@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9530Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9531returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9532and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9533digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9534a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9535digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9536
bba2971c
MS
9537@item compute CRC of memory block
9538@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9539@tab
9540@item
9541@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9542@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9543@item
9544@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9545@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9546
d4f3574e
SS
9547@item query sect offs
9548@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
9549@tab
9550Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9551image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9552response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9553offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
9554@item
9555@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9556
9557@item thread info request
9558@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9559@tab
598ca718
EZ
9560@item
9561@tab
9562@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9563Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9564encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9565@item
9566@tab reply *
9567@tab
9568See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9569
9570@item remote command
9571@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9572@tab
598ca718
EZ
9573@item
9574@tab
9575@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9576@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9577execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9578Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9579number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9580packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9581stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9582@item
9583@tab reply @code{OK}
9584@tab
9585A command response with no output.
9586@item
9587@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9588@tab
9589A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9590@item
9591@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9592@tab
9593Indicate a badly formed request.
9594
9595@item
9596@tab reply @samp{}
9597@tab
9598When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9599
9600@end multitable
9601
9602The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9603In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9604bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9605space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9606The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9607least-significant.
9608
9609@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9610
9611@item MIPS32
9612@tab
9613All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
961432 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9615registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9616
9617@item MIPS64
9618@tab
9619All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9620thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9621as @code{MIPS32}.
9622
9623@end multitable
9624
104c1213
JM
9625Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9626does not get any direct output:
9627
9628@example
9629<- @code{R00}
9630-> @code{+}
9631@emph{target restarts}
9632<- @code{?}
9633-> @code{+}
9634-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9635<- @code{+}
9636@end example
9637
9638Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9639
9640@example
9641<- @code{G1445...}
9642-> @code{+}
9643<- @code{s}
9644-> @code{+}
9645@emph{time passes}
9646-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9647<- @code{+}
9648<- @code{g}
9649-> @code{+}
9650-> @code{1455...}
9651<- @code{+}
9652@end example
9653
6d2ebf8b 9654@node Server
104c1213
JM
9655@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9656
9657@kindex gdbserver
9658@cindex remote connection without stubs
9659@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9660allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9661@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9662
9663@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9664because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9665that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9666@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9667@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9668because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9669also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9670started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9671Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9672the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9673do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9674by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9675choice for debugging.
9676
9677@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9678or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9679protocol.
9680
9681@table @emph
9682@item On the target machine,
9683you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9684@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9685strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9686system does all the symbol handling.
9687
9688To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9689the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9690syntax is:
9691
9692@smallexample
9693target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9694@end smallexample
9695
9696@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9697hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9698@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9699@file{/dev/com1}:
9700
9701@smallexample
9702target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9703@end smallexample
9704
9705@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9706with it.
9707
9708To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9709
9710@smallexample
9711target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9712@end smallexample
9713
9714The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9715specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9716TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9717expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9718(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9719you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9720TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9721reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9722conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 9723and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
9724@code{target remote} command.
9725
9726@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9727you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9728symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9729using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9730(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9731running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9732remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9733is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9734@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9735@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9736
9737@smallexample
9738(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9739@end smallexample
9740
9741@noindent
9742communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9743
9744@smallexample
9745(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9746@end smallexample
9747
9748@noindent
9749communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9750For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9751the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9752text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9753@samp{Connection refused}.
9754@end table
9755
6d2ebf8b 9756@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
9757@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9758
9759@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9760@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9761allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9762@code{target remote}.
9763
9764@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9765using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9766
9767@table @emph
9768@item On the target machine,
9769you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9770@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9771can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9772host system does all the symbol handling.
9773
9774To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9775@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9776program. The syntax is:
9777
5d161b24 9778@smallexample
104c1213
JM
9779load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9780 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9781@end smallexample
9782
9783@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9784the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 9785to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
9786
9787For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 9788communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 9789using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
9790
9791@smallexample
9792load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9793@end smallexample
9794
9795@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9796you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9797symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9798using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9799(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9800running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9801remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9802argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9803@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9804
9805@smallexample
9806(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9807@end smallexample
9808
9809@noindent
9810communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9811@end table
9812
6d2ebf8b 9813@node KOD
104c1213
JM
9814@section Kernel Object Display
9815
9816@cindex kernel object display
9817@cindex kernel object
9818@cindex KOD
9819
9820Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9821@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9822and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9823mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9824displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9825
9826Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9827@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9828
9829@example
2df3850c 9830(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
9831@end example
9832
9833If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9834about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9835which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9836after the operating system:
9837
9838@example
2df3850c 9839(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
9840List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9841Object Description
9842any Any and all objects
9843@end example
9844
9845Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9846by the kernel.
9847
9848There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
9849is supported other than to try it.
9850
9851
6d2ebf8b 9852@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
9853@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9854
9855While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9856cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9857describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9858
9859There are three major categories of configurations: native
9860configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9861operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9862different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9863are quite different from each other.
9864
9865@menu
9866* Native::
9867* Embedded OS::
9868* Embedded Processors::
9869* Architectures::
9870@end menu
9871
6d2ebf8b 9872@node Native
104c1213
JM
9873@section Native
9874
9875This section describes details specific to particular native
9876configurations.
9877
9878@menu
9879* HP-UX:: HP-UX
9880* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9881@end menu
9882
6d2ebf8b 9883@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
9884@subsection HP-UX
9885
9886On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9887begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9888name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9889
6d2ebf8b 9890@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
9891@subsection SVR4 process information
9892
9893@kindex /proc
9894@cindex process image
9895
9896Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9897used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9898subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9899this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9900several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9901@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9902@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9903and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9904
9905@table @code
9906@kindex info proc
9907@item info proc
9908Summarize available information about the process.
9909
9910@kindex info proc mappings
9911@item info proc mappings
9912Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9913on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9914
9915@kindex info proc times
9916@item info proc times
9917Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9918its children.
9919
9920@kindex info proc id
9921@item info proc id
9922Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9923the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9924
9925@kindex info proc status
9926@item info proc status
9927General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9928stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9929received.
9930
9931@item info proc all
9932Show all the above information about the process.
9933@end table
9934
6d2ebf8b 9935@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
9936@section Embedded Operating Systems
9937
9938This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9939embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9940architectures.
9941
9942@menu
9943* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9944@end menu
9945
9946@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9947various real-time operating systems.
9948
6d2ebf8b 9949@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
9950@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9951
9952@cindex VxWorks
9953
9954@table @code
9955
9956@kindex target vxworks
9957@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9958A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9959is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9960
9961@end table
9962
9963On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9964current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9965
9966@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9967VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9968the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9969both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 9970@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 9971installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 9972@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
9973
9974@table @code
9975@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9976@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
9977All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9978This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9979seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9980your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
9981of a thin network line.
9982@end table
9983
9984The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9985this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9986procedures.
9987
9988@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9989To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9990to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9991library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9992VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9993kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9994source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9995information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9996manual.
9997@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9998
9999Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10000your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
10001run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10002@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
10003
10004@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10005
10006@example
10007(vxgdb)
10008@end example
10009
10010@menu
10011* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10012* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10013* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10014@end menu
10015
6d2ebf8b 10016@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
10017@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10018
10019The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10020network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10021
10022@example
10023(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10024@end example
10025
10026@need 750
10027@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10028
10029@smallexample
5d161b24 10030Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
10031Connected to tt.
10032@end smallexample
10033
10034@need 1000
10035@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10036loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10037these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10038path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10039to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10040
10041@example
10042prog.o: No such file or directory.
10043@end example
10044
10045When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10046the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10047command again.
10048
6d2ebf8b 10049@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
10050@subsubsection VxWorks download
10051
10052@cindex download to VxWorks
10053If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10054object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10055@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10056incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10057command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10058to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10059table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10060the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10061filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10062Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10063to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10064the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10065@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10066and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10067program, type this on VxWorks:
10068
10069@example
10070-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10071@end example
d4f3574e
SS
10072
10073@noindent
104c1213
JM
10074Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10075
10076@example
5d161b24 10077(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
10078(vxgdb) load prog.o
10079@end example
10080
10081@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10082
10083@smallexample
10084Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10085@end smallexample
10086
10087You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10088after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10089this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10090auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10091history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 10092debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
10093table.)
10094
6d2ebf8b 10095@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
10096@subsubsection Running tasks
10097
10098@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10099You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10100follows:
10101
10102@example
10103(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10104@end example
10105
10106@noindent
10107where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10108or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10109the time of attachment.
10110
6d2ebf8b 10111@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
10112@section Embedded Processors
10113
10114This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10115configurations.
10116
10117@menu
10118* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10119* ARM:: ARM
10120* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10121* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10122* i960:: Intel i960
10123* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10124* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10125* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10126* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10127* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10128* PowerPC: PowerPC
10129* SH:: Hitachi SH
10130* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10131* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10132* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10133* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10134@end menu
10135
6d2ebf8b 10136@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
10137@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10138
10139@menu
10140* A29K UDI::
10141* A29K EB29K::
10142* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10143* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10144* Remote Log:: Remote log
10145@end menu
10146
10147@table @code
10148
10149@kindex target adapt
10150@item target adapt @var{dev}
10151Adapt monitor for A29K.
10152
10153@kindex target amd-eb
10154@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10155@cindex AMD EB29K
10156Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10157@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10158@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10159name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10160@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10161
10162@end table
10163
6d2ebf8b 10164@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
10165@subsubsection A29K UDI
10166
10167@cindex UDI
10168@cindex AMD29K via UDI
10169
10170@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10171protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10172configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10173program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10174use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10175@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10176
10177@table @code
10178@item target udi @var{keyword}
10179@kindex udi
10180Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10181@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10182This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10183connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10184working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10185to its pathname.
10186@end table
10187
6d2ebf8b 10188@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
10189@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10190
10191@cindex EB29K board
10192@cindex running 29K programs
10193
10194AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10195with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10196term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10197@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10198must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10199board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10200assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10201@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10202
6d2ebf8b 10203@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
10204@subsubsection Communications setup
10205
10206The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10207in DOS on the PC:
10208
10209@example
10210C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10211@end example
10212
10213@noindent
10214This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10215bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10216you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10217end of the connection as well.
10218@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 10219@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10220@c
10221@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10222@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10223@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10224@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10225@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
10226
10227To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10228the following at the DOS console:
10229
10230@example
10231C:\> CTTY com1
10232@end example
10233
10234@noindent
10235(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10236the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 10237had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
10238
10239From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10240@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10241
10242@example
10243cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10244@end example
10245
10246@noindent
10247The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10248serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10249may look something like the following:
10250
10251@example
10252tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10253@end example
10254
10255@noindent
10256Your system may require a different name where we show
10257@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
10258parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10259@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10260system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10261@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10262@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
10263@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10264@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
10265@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10266@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10267@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10268@c
10269@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
10270@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
10271@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
10272
10273@kindex EBMON
10274Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
10275directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
10276start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
10277with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
10278@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
10279@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
10280
10281@example
10282C:\> G:
10283
10284G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
10285
10286G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
10287Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
10288Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
10289Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
10290
10291Enter '?' or 'H' for help
10292
10293PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
10294I/O Base = 0x208
10295Memory Base = 0xd0000
10296
10297Data Memory Size = 2048KB
10298Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
10299Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
10300
10301PageSize = 0x400
10302Register Stack Size = 0x800
10303Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
10304
10305CPU PRL = 0x3
10306Am29027 Available = No
10307Byte Write Available = Yes
10308
10309# ~.
10310@end example
10311
10312Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10313typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10314running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10315
10316For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10317way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 10318system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
10319PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10320something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10321other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10322from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10323serial line.
10324
6d2ebf8b 10325@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
10326@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10327
10328Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10329program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10330name of your 29K program:
10331
10332@example
10333cd /usr/joe/work29k
10334@value{GDBP} myfoo
10335@end example
10336
10337@need 500
10338Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10339
10340@example
10341target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10342@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10343@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10344@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10345@end example
10346
10347@noindent
10348In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10349@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10350@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10351In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10352a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10353the name on the Unix side.
10354
10355At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10356to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10357@code{run}.
10358
10359To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10360command.
10361
10362To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10363once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10364@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10365@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 10366Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
10367and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10368
6d2ebf8b 10369@node Remote Log
104c1213 10370@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 10371@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
10372@cindex log file for EB29K
10373
10374The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10375current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10376@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10377of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10378another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10379unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10380
6d2ebf8b 10381@node ARM
104c1213
JM
10382@subsection ARM
10383
10384@table @code
10385
10386@kindex target rdi
10387@item target rdi @var{dev}
10388ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10389use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10390monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 10391
104c1213
JM
10392@kindex target rdp
10393@item target rdp @var{dev}
10394ARM Demon monitor.
10395
10396@end table
10397
6d2ebf8b 10398@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
10399@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10400
10401@table @code
10402
d4f3574e 10403@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10404@item target hms @var{dev}
10405A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10406Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10407line and the communications speed used.
10408
d4f3574e 10409@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10410@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10411E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10412
d4f3574e
SS
10413@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10414@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 10415@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 10416@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
10417Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10418
10419@end table
10420
10421@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10422@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10423@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10424@cindex Hitachi SH download
10425When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10426board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10427board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10428@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10429
10430@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 10431Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
10432
10433@enumerate
10434@item
10435that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10436for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10437emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 10438the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
10439H8/300, or H8/500.)
10440
10441@item
10442what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10443serial device available on your host is the default).
10444
10445@item
10446what speed to use over the serial device.
10447@end enumerate
10448
10449@menu
10450* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10451* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10452* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10453@end menu
10454
6d2ebf8b 10455@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
10456@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10457
10458@c only for Unix hosts
10459@kindex device
10460@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10461Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
10462need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10463first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10464hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10465
10466@kindex speed
10467@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10468@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 10469speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 10470hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
10471the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10472@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
10473
10474The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10475use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10476use a DOS host,
10477@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10478called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10479through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10480to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10481
10482The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10483program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10484sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10485the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10486
10487First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10488board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10489port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10490When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 10491debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
10492for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10493@code{COM2}.
10494
10495@example
10496C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10497C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10498
10499Resident portion of MODE loaded
10500
10501COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10502
10503@end example
10504
10505@quotation
10506@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10507@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10508disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10509your development board.
10510@end quotation
10511
d4f3574e 10512@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
10513Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10514connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 10515the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
10516you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10517commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10518cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10519download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10520the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10521(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10522executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10523@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10524itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10525
10526@smallexample
10527(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 10528@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 10529 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 10530 the conditions.
5d161b24 10531There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 10532for details.
2df3850c
JM
10533@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10534(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 10535Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 10536(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
10537.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10538.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10539.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10540@end smallexample
10541
10542At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10543you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10544sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10545@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10546resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10547@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10548
10549Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10550available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10551you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10552
10553Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10554@itemize @bullet
10555@item
10556to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10557no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10558
10559@item
10560to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10561normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10562to detect program completion.
10563@end itemize
10564
10565In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10566development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10567
6d2ebf8b 10568@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
10569@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10570
d4f3574e 10571@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
10572You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10573Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10574e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10575
10576@table @code
10577@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10578Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10579@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10580@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10581(for example, @samp{9600}).
10582
10583@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10584If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10585specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10586@end table
10587
6d2ebf8b 10588@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
10589@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10590
10591Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10592
10593@table @code
10594
10595@kindex set machine
10596@kindex show machine
10597@item set machine h8300
10598@itemx set machine h8300h
10599Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10600architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10601to check which variant is currently in effect.
10602
10603@end table
10604
6d2ebf8b 10605@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
10606@subsection H8/500
10607
10608@table @code
10609
10610@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10611@cindex memory models, H8/500
10612@item set memory @var{mod}
10613@itemx show memory
10614Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10615@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10616memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10617@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10618
10619@end table
10620
6d2ebf8b 10621@node i960
104c1213
JM
10622@subsection Intel i960
10623
10624@table @code
10625
10626@kindex target mon960
10627@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10628MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10629
f0ca3dce 10630@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
10631@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10632An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10633the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10634@file{/dev/ttya}.
10635
10636@end table
10637
10638@cindex Nindy
10639@cindex i960
10640@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10641@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10642tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10643
10644@itemize @bullet
10645@item
10646Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10647Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10648
10649@item
10650By responding to a prompt on startup;
10651
10652@item
10653By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10654session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10655
104c1213
JM
10656@end itemize
10657
10658@cindex download to Nindy-960
10659With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10660downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10661@value{GDBN}.
10662
10663@menu
10664* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10665* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10666* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10667@end menu
10668
6d2ebf8b 10669@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
10670@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10671
10672If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10673options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10674reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10675
10676@example
5d161b24 10677Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
10678@end example
10679
10680@noindent
10681Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10682identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10683simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10684with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10685use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10686
6d2ebf8b 10687@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
10688@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10689
10690These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10691Nindy-960 board attached:
10692
10693@table @code
10694@item -r @var{port}
10695Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10696to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10697configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10698@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10699device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10700suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10701
10702@item -O
10703(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10704the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10705This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10706target architecture.
10707
10708@quotation
10709@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10710connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10711fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10712attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10713this process with an interrupt.
10714@end quotation
10715
10716@item -brk
10717Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10718system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10719
10720@quotation
10721@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10722requires; it only works with a few boards.
10723@end quotation
10724@end table
10725
10726The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10727port.
10728
10729@c @group
6d2ebf8b 10730@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
10731@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10732
10733@table @code
10734@item reset
10735@kindex reset
10736For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10737system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10738circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10739a break is detected.
10740@end table
10741@c @end group
10742
6d2ebf8b 10743@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
10744@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10745
10746@table @code
10747
10748@kindex target m32r
10749@item target m32r @var{dev}
10750Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10751
10752@end table
10753
6d2ebf8b 10754@node M68K
104c1213
JM
10755@subsection M68k
10756
10757The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10758target command for the following ROM monitors.
10759
10760@table @code
10761
10762@kindex target abug
10763@item target abug @var{dev}
10764ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10765
10766@kindex target cpu32bug
10767@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10768CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10769
10770@kindex target dbug
10771@item target dbug @var{dev}
10772dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10773
10774@kindex target est
10775@item target est @var{dev}
10776EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10777
10778@kindex target rom68k
10779@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10780ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10781
10782@end table
10783
10784If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10785instead have only a single special target command:
10786
10787@table @code
10788
10789@kindex target es1800
10790@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10791ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10792
10793@end table
10794
10795[context?]
10796
10797@table @code
10798
10799@kindex target rombug
10800@item target rombug @var{dev}
10801ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10802
10803@end table
10804
6d2ebf8b 10805@node M88K
104c1213
JM
10806@subsection M88K
10807
10808@table @code
10809
10810@kindex target bug
10811@item target bug @var{dev}
10812BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10813
10814@end table
10815
6d2ebf8b 10816@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
10817@subsection MIPS Embedded
10818
10819@cindex MIPS boards
10820@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10821MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10822you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10823
10824@need 1000
10825Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10826
10827@table @code
10828@item target mips @var{port}
10829@kindex target mips @var{port}
10830To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10831name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10832command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10833the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10834been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10835download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10836
10837For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10838port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10839debugger:
10840
10841@example
10842host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
10843@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10844(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10845(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10846(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
10847@end example
10848
10849@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10850On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10851connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10852concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10853@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10854
10855@item target pmon @var{port}
10856@kindex target pmon @var{port}
10857PMON ROM monitor.
10858
10859@item target ddb @var{port}
10860@kindex target ddb @var{port}
10861NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10862
10863@item target lsi @var{port}
10864@kindex target lsi @var{port}
10865LSI variant of PMON.
10866
10867@kindex target r3900
10868@item target r3900 @var{dev}
10869Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10870
10871@kindex target array
10872@item target array @var{dev}
10873Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10874
10875@end table
10876
10877
10878@noindent
10879@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10880
10881@table @code
10882@item set processor @var{args}
10883@itemx show processor
10884@kindex set processor @var{args}
10885@kindex show processor
10886Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10887processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 10888For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 10889to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 10890Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 10891is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 10892@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
10893
10894@item set mipsfpu double
10895@itemx set mipsfpu single
10896@itemx set mipsfpu none
10897@itemx show mipsfpu
10898@kindex set mipsfpu
10899@kindex show mipsfpu
10900@cindex MIPS remote floating point
10901@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10902If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10903coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 10904need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
10905file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10906functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10907@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10908functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10909with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10910processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10911double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10912@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10913
10914In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10915floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10916and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10917
10918As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10919@samp{show mipsfpu}.
10920
10921@item set remotedebug @var{n}
10922@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
10923@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10924@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
10925@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10926@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10927@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10928@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10929You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10930by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10931@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10932to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10933at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10934
10935@item set timeout @var{seconds}
10936@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10937@itemx show timeout
10938@itemx show retransmit-timeout
10939@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10940@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10941@kindex set timeout
10942@kindex show timeout
10943@kindex set retransmit-timeout
10944@kindex show retransmit-timeout
10945You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10946remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10947default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10948waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10949retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10950You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10951retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10952@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10953
10954The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10955is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10956forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10957to run before stopping.
10958@end table
10959
6d2ebf8b 10960@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
10961@subsection PowerPC
10962
10963@table @code
10964
10965@kindex target dink32
10966@item target dink32 @var{dev}
10967DINK32 ROM monitor.
10968
10969@kindex target ppcbug
10970@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10971@kindex target ppcbug1
10972@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10973PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10974
10975@kindex target sds
10976@item target sds @var{dev}
10977SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10978
10979@end table
10980
6d2ebf8b 10981@node PA
104c1213
JM
10982@subsection HP PA Embedded
10983
10984@table @code
10985
10986@kindex target op50n
10987@item target op50n @var{dev}
10988OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10989
10990@kindex target w89k
10991@item target w89k @var{dev}
10992W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10993
10994@end table
10995
6d2ebf8b 10996@node SH
104c1213
JM
10997@subsection Hitachi SH
10998
10999@table @code
11000
d4f3574e 11001@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11002@item target hms @var{dev}
11003A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11004commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11005the communications speed used.
11006
d4f3574e 11007@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11008@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11009E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11010
d4f3574e
SS
11011@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11012@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
11013@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11014@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11015Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11016
11017@end table
11018
6d2ebf8b 11019@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11020@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11021
11022@cindex Sparclet
11023
5d161b24
DB
11024@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11025Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11026@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11027both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 11028@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11029
11030@table @code
f0ca3dce 11031@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 11032@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
11033@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11034This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11035seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11036@end table
11037
41afff9a 11038@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 11039When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 11040information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 11041load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 11042@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
11043
11044@example
11045sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11046@end example
11047
d4f3574e 11048You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
11049
11050@example
11051sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11052@end example
11053
41afff9a 11054@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11055Once you have set
11056your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 11057run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
11058(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11059
11060@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11061
11062@example
11063(gdbslet)
11064@end example
11065
11066@menu
11067* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11068* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11069* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 11070* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11071@end menu
11072
6d2ebf8b 11073@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
11074@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11075
11076The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11077
11078@example
11079(gdbslet) file prog
11080@end example
11081
11082@need 1000
11083@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11084@value{GDBN} locates
11085the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11086path.
11087If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11088files will be searched as well.
11089@value{GDBN} locates
11090the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11091path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11092If it fails
11093to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11094
11095@example
11096prog: No such file or directory.
11097@end example
11098
11099When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 11100the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
11101@code{target} command again.
11102
6d2ebf8b 11103@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
11104@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11105
11106The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11107To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11108
11109@example
11110(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11111Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 11112main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
11113@end example
11114
11115@need 750
11116@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11117
d4f3574e 11118@example
104c1213 11119Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 11120@end example
104c1213 11121
6d2ebf8b 11122@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
11123@subsubsection Sparclet download
11124
11125@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 11126Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
11127you can use the @value{GDBN}
11128@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11129The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11130command.
5d161b24 11131Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 11132address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
11133offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11134of each of the file's sections.
11135For instance, if the program
11136@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11137and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11138
11139@example
11140(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11141Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11142@end example
11143
5d161b24
DB
11144If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11145to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
11146to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11147
6d2ebf8b 11148@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
11149@subsubsection Running and debugging
11150
11151@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11152You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 11153commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
11154manual for the list of commands.
11155
11156@example
11157(gdbslet) b main
11158Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 11159(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
11160Starting program: prog
11161Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
111623 char *symarg = 0;
11163(gdbslet) step
111644 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 11165(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
11166@end example
11167
6d2ebf8b 11168@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
11169@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11170
11171@table @code
11172
11173@kindex target sparclite
11174@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
11175Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11176You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11177For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
11178remote protocol.
11179
11180@end table
11181
6d2ebf8b 11182@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
11183@subsection Tandem ST2000
11184
2df3850c 11185@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
11186STDBUG protocol.
11187
11188To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11189manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11190
11191@example
11192target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11193@end example
11194
11195@noindent
11196to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11197the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11198ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11199connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11200concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11201
11202The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11203this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11204would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11205(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11206available on your host computer.
11207@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11208@c basically hearsay.
11209
11210@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11211These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11212environment:
11213
11214@table @code
11215@item st2000 @var{command}
11216@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11217@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11218@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11219Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11220manual for available commands.
11221
11222@item connect
11223@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11224Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11225you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11226sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11227@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11228@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11229@end table
11230
6d2ebf8b 11231@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
11232@subsection Zilog Z8000
11233
11234@cindex Z8000
11235@cindex simulator, Z8000
11236@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11237
11238When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11239a Z8000 simulator.
11240
11241For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11242unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11243segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11244appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11245
11246@table @code
11247@item target sim @var{args}
11248@kindex sim
d4f3574e 11249@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
11250Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11251options, specify them via @var{args}.
11252@end table
11253
11254@noindent
11255After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11256CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11257@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11258to run your program, and so on.
11259
d4f3574e
SS
11260As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11261(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11262additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
11263
11264@table @code
11265
11266@item cycles
11267Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
11268
11269@item insts
11270Counts instructions run in the simulator.
11271
11272@item time
11273Execution time in 60ths of a second.
11274
11275@end table
11276
11277You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11278conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11279conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11280simulated clock ticks.
11281
6d2ebf8b 11282@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
11283@section Architectures
11284
11285This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 11286all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
11287
11288@menu
11289* A29K::
11290* Alpha::
11291* MIPS::
11292@end menu
11293
6d2ebf8b 11294@node A29K
104c1213
JM
11295@subsection A29K
11296
11297@table @code
11298
11299@kindex set rstack_high_address
11300@cindex AMD 29K register stack
11301@cindex register stack, AMD29K
11302@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11303On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 11304@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
11305extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11306stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11307memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11308this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11309the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11310address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11311hexadecimal.
11312
11313@kindex show rstack_high_address
11314@item show rstack_high_address
11315Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11316processors.
11317
11318@end table
11319
6d2ebf8b 11320@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
11321@subsection Alpha
11322
11323See the following section.
11324
6d2ebf8b 11325@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
11326@subsection MIPS
11327
11328@cindex stack on Alpha
11329@cindex stack on MIPS
11330@cindex Alpha stack
11331@cindex MIPS stack
11332Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11333sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11334find the beginning of a function.
11335
11336@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11337To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11338@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11339you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11340commands:
11341
11342@table @code
00e4a2e4 11343@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
11344@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11345Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11346search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11347default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11348larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11349and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11350
11351@item show heuristic-fence-post
11352Display the current limit.
11353@end table
11354
11355@noindent
11356These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11357for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11358
11359
6d2ebf8b 11360@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
11361@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11362
53a5351d
JM
11363You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11364@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 11365data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 11366described here.
c906108c
SS
11367
11368@menu
11369* Prompt:: Prompt
11370* Editing:: Command editing
11371* History:: Command history
11372* Screen Size:: Screen size
11373* Numbers:: Numbers
11374* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 11375* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
11376@end menu
11377
6d2ebf8b 11378@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
11379@section Prompt
11380
11381@cindex prompt
11382
11383@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11384called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11385can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11386instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 11387the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
11388which one you are talking to.
11389
d4f3574e 11390@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
11391prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11392or a prompt that does not.
11393
11394@table @code
11395@kindex set prompt
11396@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11397Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11398
11399@kindex show prompt
11400@item show prompt
11401Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11402@end table
11403
6d2ebf8b 11404@node Editing
c906108c
SS
11405@section Command editing
11406@cindex readline
11407@cindex command line editing
11408
11409@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11410@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11411command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11412or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11413substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11414debugging sessions.
11415
11416You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11417command @code{set}.
11418
11419@table @code
11420@kindex set editing
11421@cindex editing
11422@item set editing
11423@itemx set editing on
11424Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11425
11426@item set editing off
11427Disable command line editing.
11428
11429@kindex show editing
11430@item show editing
11431Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11432@end table
11433
6d2ebf8b 11434@node History
c906108c
SS
11435@section Command history
11436
11437@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11438debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11439happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11440history facility.
11441
11442@table @code
11443@cindex history substitution
11444@cindex history file
11445@kindex set history filename
11446@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11447@item set history filename @var{fname}
11448Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11449This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11450list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11451exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11452the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11453to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
11454@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11455is not set.
c906108c
SS
11456
11457@cindex history save
11458@kindex set history save
11459@item set history save
11460@itemx set history save on
11461Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11462@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11463
11464@item set history save off
11465Stop recording command history in a file.
11466
11467@cindex history size
11468@kindex set history size
11469@item set history size @var{size}
11470Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11471This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11472@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11473@end table
11474
11475@cindex history expansion
11476History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11477@ifset have-readline-appendices
11478@xref{Event Designators}.
11479@end ifset
11480
11481Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11482is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11483@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11484follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11485a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11486history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11487@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11488
11489The commands to control history expansion are:
11490
11491@table @code
11492@kindex set history expansion
11493@item set history expansion on
11494@itemx set history expansion
11495Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11496
11497@item set history expansion off
11498Disable history expansion.
11499
11500The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11501editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11502or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11503@ifset have-readline-appendices
11504@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11505@end ifset
11506
11507@c @group
11508@kindex show history
11509@item show history
11510@itemx show history filename
11511@itemx show history save
11512@itemx show history size
11513@itemx show history expansion
11514These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11515@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11516@c @end group
11517@end table
11518
11519@table @code
41afff9a 11520@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
11521@item show commands
11522Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11523
11524@item show commands @var{n}
11525Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11526
11527@item show commands +
11528Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11529@end table
11530
6d2ebf8b 11531@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
11532@section Screen size
11533@cindex size of screen
11534@cindex pauses in output
11535
11536Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11537information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11538@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11539output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11540to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11541determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11542printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11543rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11544
d4f3574e
SS
11545Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11546driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 11547together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 11548@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
11549you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11550width} commands:
11551
11552@table @code
11553@kindex set height
11554@kindex set width
11555@kindex show width
11556@kindex show height
11557@item set height @var{lpp}
11558@itemx show height
11559@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11560@itemx show width
11561These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11562a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11563commands display the current settings.
11564
5d161b24
DB
11565If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11566output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
11567file or to an editor buffer.
11568
11569Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11570from wrapping its output.
11571@end table
11572
6d2ebf8b 11573@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
11574@section Numbers
11575@cindex number representation
11576@cindex entering numbers
11577
2df3850c
JM
11578You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11579@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11580@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11581begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11582default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11583numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11584change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11585radix} command.
c906108c
SS
11586
11587@table @code
11588@kindex set input-radix
11589@item set input-radix @var{base}
11590Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11591for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11592specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11593example, any of
11594
11595@smallexample
11596set radix 012
11597set radix 10.
11598set radix 0xa
11599@end smallexample
11600
11601@noindent
11602sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11603leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11604
11605@kindex set output-radix
11606@item set output-radix @var{base}
11607Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11608for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11609specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11610
11611@kindex show input-radix
11612@item show input-radix
11613Display the current default base for numeric input.
11614
11615@kindex show output-radix
11616@item show output-radix
11617Display the current default base for numeric display.
11618@end table
11619
6d2ebf8b 11620@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
11621@section Optional warnings and messages
11622
2df3850c
JM
11623By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11624running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11625command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11626internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
11627
11628Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11629which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11630see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11631
11632@table @code
11633@kindex set verbose
11634@item set verbose on
11635Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11636
11637@item set verbose off
11638Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11639
11640@kindex show verbose
11641@item show verbose
11642Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11643@end table
11644
2df3850c
JM
11645By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11646object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11647find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11648symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
11649
11650@table @code
2df3850c 11651
c906108c
SS
11652@kindex set complaints
11653@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
11654Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11655unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11656@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11657to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
11658
11659@kindex show complaints
11660@item show complaints
11661Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 11662
c906108c
SS
11663@end table
11664
11665By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11666lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11667you try to run a program which is already running:
11668
11669@example
11670(@value{GDBP}) run
11671The program being debugged has been started already.
11672Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11673@end example
11674
11675If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11676commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11677
11678@table @code
2df3850c 11679
c906108c
SS
11680@kindex set confirm
11681@cindex flinching
11682@cindex confirmation
11683@cindex stupid questions
11684@item set confirm off
11685Disables confirmation requests.
11686
11687@item set confirm on
11688Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11689
11690@kindex show confirm
11691@item show confirm
11692Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 11693
c906108c
SS
11694@end table
11695
6d2ebf8b 11696@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
11697@section Optional messages about internal happenings
11698@table @code
11699@kindex set debug arch
11700@item set debug arch
11701Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
11702@kindex show debug arch
11703@item show debug arch
11704Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
11705@kindex set debug event
11706@item set debug event
11707Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
11708default is off.
11709@kindex show debug event
11710@item show debug event
11711Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
11712info.
11713@kindex set debug expression
11714@item set debug expression
11715Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
11716default is off.
11717@kindex show debug expression
11718@item show debug expression
11719Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
11720debugging info.
11721@kindex set debug overload
11722@item set debug overload
11723Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C++ overload debugging
11724info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
11725is off.
11726@kindex show debug overload
11727@item show debug overload
11728Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C++ overload
11729debugging info.
11730@kindex set debug remote
11731@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
11732@cindex serial connections, debugging
11733@item set debug remote
11734Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
11735the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
11736@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
11737@kindex show debug remote
11738@item show debug remote
11739Displays the state of display of remote packets.
11740@kindex set debug serial
11741@item set debug serial
11742Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
11743default is off.
11744@kindex show debug serial
11745@item show debug serial
11746Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
11747info.
11748@kindex set debug target
11749@item set debug target
11750Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
11751includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
11752default is off.
11753@kindex show debug target
11754@item show debug target
11755Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
11756info.
11757@kindex set debug varobj
11758@item set debug varobj
11759Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
11760info. The default is off.
11761@kindex show debug varobj
11762@item show debug varobj
11763Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
11764debugging info.
11765@end table
11766
6d2ebf8b 11767@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
11768@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11769
11770Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
11771command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11772commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11773files.
c906108c
SS
11774
11775@menu
11776* Define:: User-defined commands
11777* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11778* Command Files:: Command files
11779* Output:: Commands for controlled output
11780@end menu
11781
6d2ebf8b 11782@node Define
c906108c
SS
11783@section User-defined commands
11784
11785@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
11786A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11787which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11788@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11789separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11790via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
11791
11792@smallexample
11793define adder
11794 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11795@end smallexample
11796
d4f3574e
SS
11797@noindent
11798To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
11799
11800@smallexample
11801adder 1 2 3
11802@end smallexample
11803
d4f3574e
SS
11804@noindent
11805This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 11806its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
11807reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11808functions calls.
11809
11810@table @code
2df3850c 11811
c906108c
SS
11812@kindex define
11813@item define @var{commandname}
11814Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11815by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11816
11817The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11818which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11819commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11820
11821@kindex if
11822@kindex else
11823@item if
11824Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11825It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11826only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11827There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11828by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11829was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11830
11831@kindex while
11832@item while
11833The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11834which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11835execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11836The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11837evaluates to true.
11838
11839@kindex document
11840@item document @var{commandname}
11841Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
11842accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11843defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11844reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11845After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
11846@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11847
11848You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11849documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11850does not change the documentation.
11851
11852@kindex help user-defined
11853@item help user-defined
11854List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11855(if any) for each.
11856
11857@kindex show user
11858@item show user
11859@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
11860Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11861not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 11862definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 11863
c906108c
SS
11864@end table
11865
11866When user-defined commands are executed, the
11867commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11868stops execution of the user-defined command.
11869
11870If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
11871without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11872commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
11873messages when used in a user-defined command.
11874
6d2ebf8b 11875@node Hooks
c906108c 11876@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
11877@cindex command hooks
11878@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 11879@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 11880
c78b4128
EZ
11881@kindex hook
11882@kindex hook-
11883You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
11884command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11885command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11886before that command.
11887
c78b4128
EZ
11888@cindex hooks, post-command
11889@kindex hookpost
11890@kindex hookpost-
11891A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
11892Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
11893@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
11894that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
11895pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
11896
11897It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
11898occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
11899
11900@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
11901@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
11902
d4f3574e 11903@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
11904In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11905(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11906execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11907displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11908
c906108c
SS
11909For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11910single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11911you could define:
11912
11913@example
11914define hook-stop
11915handle SIGALRM nopass
11916end
11917
11918define hook-run
11919handle SIGALRM pass
11920end
11921
11922define hook-continue
11923handle SIGLARM pass
11924end
11925@end example
c906108c 11926
c78b4128
EZ
11927As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
11928command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
11929you could define:
11930
11931@example
11932define hook-echo
11933echo <<<---
11934end
11935
11936define hookpost-echo
11937echo --->>>\n
11938end
11939
11940(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
11941<<<---Hello World--->>>
11942(@value{GDBP})
11943
11944@end example
11945
c906108c
SS
11946You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11947not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11948name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11949@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11950@c or not?
11951If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11952@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11953(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11954
11955If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11956get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11957
6d2ebf8b 11958@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
11959@section Command files
11960
11961@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
11962A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11963commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11964An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
11965the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11966
11967@cindex init file
11968@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 11969@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 11970When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
11971@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
11972@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
11973following:
11974
11975@enumerate
11976@item
11977Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
11978DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
11979@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
11980
11981@item
11982Processes command line options and operands.
11983
11984@item
11985Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
11986
11987@item
11988Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
11989@end enumerate
11990
11991The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
11992complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
11993and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
11994option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 11995
c906108c
SS
11996@cindex init file name
11997On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11998different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11999form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12000different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12001environments with special init file names:
12002
00e4a2e4 12003@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
12004@itemize @bullet
12005@item
00e4a2e4 12006VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12007
00e4a2e4 12008@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12009@item
00e4a2e4 12010OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12011
00e4a2e4 12012@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12013@item
00e4a2e4 12014ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12015@end itemize
c906108c
SS
12016
12017You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12018@code{source} command:
12019
12020@table @code
12021@kindex source
12022@item source @var{filename}
12023Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12024@end table
12025
12026The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12027printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12028of the command file.
12029
12030Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12031without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12032normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12033when called from command files.
12034
6d2ebf8b 12035@node Output
c906108c
SS
12036@section Commands for controlled output
12037
12038During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12039@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12040explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12041describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12042want.
12043
12044@table @code
12045@kindex echo
12046@item echo @var{text}
12047@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12048@c because it is not in ANSI.
12049Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12050@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12051newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12052In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12053by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12054string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 12055trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
12056To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12057@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12058
12059A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12060the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12061
12062@example
12063echo This is some text\n\
12064which is continued\n\
12065onto several lines.\n
12066@end example
12067
12068produces the same output as
12069
12070@example
12071echo This is some text\n
12072echo which is continued\n
12073echo onto several lines.\n
12074@end example
12075
12076@kindex output
12077@item output @var{expression}
12078Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12079newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 12080value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
12081on expressions.
12082
12083@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12084Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12085the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12086formats}, for more information.
12087
12088@kindex printf
12089@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12090Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12091@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12092either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12093@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12094subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
12095@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12096@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12097@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12098@c supported.
c906108c
SS
12099
12100@example
12101printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12102@end example
12103
12104For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12105
12106@smallexample
12107printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12108@end smallexample
12109
12110The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12111string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12112letter.
12113@end table
12114
6d2ebf8b 12115@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
12116@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12117
12118@cindex Emacs
12119@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12120A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12121edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12122@value{GDBN}.
12123
12124To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12125executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12126@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12127created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 12128@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
12129
12130Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12131things:
12132
12133@itemize @bullet
12134@item
12135All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12136@end itemize
12137
12138This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12139and output done by the program you are debugging.
12140
12141This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12142commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12143in this way.
12144
12145All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
12146with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
12147way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
12148stop.
12149
12150@itemize @bullet
12151@item
12152@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
12153@end itemize
12154
12155Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
12156source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
12157left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
12158source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
12159and the source.
12160
12161Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
12162usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
12163
12164@quotation
12165@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
12166current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
12167the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
12168appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
12169environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
12170session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
12171back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
12172avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
12173your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
12174@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
12175
12176A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
12177switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
12178@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
12179@end quotation
12180
12181By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
12182you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
12183several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
12184Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
12185
12186@example
12187(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
12188@end example
12189
12190@noindent
d4f3574e 12191(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
12192in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
12193``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
12194
12195In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
12196addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
12197
12198@table @kbd
12199@item C-h m
12200Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
12201
12202@item M-s
12203Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
12204update the display window to show the current file and location.
12205
12206@item M-n
12207Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
12208calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
12209to show the current file and location.
12210
12211@item M-i
12212Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
12213display window accordingly.
12214
12215@item M-x gdb-nexti
12216Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
12217display window accordingly.
12218
12219@item C-c C-f
12220Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
12221@code{finish} command.
12222
12223@item M-c
12224Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
12225command.
12226
12227@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
12228
12229@item M-u
12230Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
12231(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
12232like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
12233
12234@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
12235
12236@item M-d
12237Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
12238@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
12239
12240@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
12241
12242@item C-x &
12243Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
12244of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
12245around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
12246then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
12247argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
12248
12249You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
12250@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
12251otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
12252inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
12253wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
12254list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
12255formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
12256is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
12257@end table
12258
12259In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
12260tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
12261
12262If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
12263it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
12264request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
12265the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
12266frame.
12267
12268The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
12269which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
12270the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
12271communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
12272delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
12273to correspond properly with the code.
12274
12275@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
12276@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
12277@ignore
12278@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
12279@kindex Epoch
12280@kindex inspect
12281
5d161b24 12282Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
12283called the @code{epoch}
12284environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
12285@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
12286each value is printed in its own window.
12287@end ignore
c906108c 12288
d700128c 12289@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 12290@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 12291
6d2ebf8b 12292@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
12293@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
12294@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
12295@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
12296
12297Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
12298
12299Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
12300may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
12301the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
12302reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
12303
12304In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
12305information that enables us to fix the bug.
12306
12307@menu
12308* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
12309* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
12310@end menu
12311
6d2ebf8b 12312@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
12313@section Have you found a bug?
12314@cindex bug criteria
12315
12316If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
12317
12318@itemize @bullet
12319@cindex fatal signal
12320@cindex debugger crash
12321@cindex crash of debugger
12322@item
12323If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
12324@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
12325
12326@cindex error on valid input
12327@item
12328If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
12329bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
12330somewhere in the connection to the target.)
12331
12332@cindex invalid input
12333@item
12334If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
12335that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
12336``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
12337for traditional practice''.
12338
12339@item
12340If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
12341for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
12342@end itemize
12343
6d2ebf8b 12344@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
12345@section How to report bugs
12346@cindex bug reports
12347@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
12348
c906108c
SS
12349A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
12350If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
12351contact that organization first.
12352
12353You can find contact information for many support companies and
12354individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
12355distribution.
12356@c should add a web page ref...
12357
12358In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
12359@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
12360
12361@example
d4f3574e 12362bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
12363@end example
12364
12365@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 12366@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
12367not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
12368@samp{bug-gdb}.
12369
12370The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
12371serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
12372the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
12373newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
12374problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
12375path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
12376we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
12377bug reports to the mailing list.
12378
12379As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
12380
12381@example
12382@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
12383Free Software Foundation Inc.
1238459 Temple Place - Suite 330
12385Boston, MA 02111-1307
12386USA
12387@end example
c906108c
SS
12388
12389The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
12390@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
12391fact or leave it out, state it!
12392
12393Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
12394problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
12395assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
12396Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
12397stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
12398name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
12399of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
12400the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
12401easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
12402
12403Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
12404bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
12405you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
12406self-contained.
12407
12408Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
12409bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
12410@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
12411bugs properly.
12412
12413To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
12414
12415@itemize @bullet
12416@item
12417The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
12418with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
12419version}.
12420
12421Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
12422the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12423
12424@item
12425The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12426version number.
12427
c906108c
SS
12428@item
12429What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12430``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
12431
12432@item
12433What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12434debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12435C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12436information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12437compilers.
12438
12439@item
12440The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12441observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12442you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12443Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12444
12445If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12446and then we might not encounter the bug.
12447
12448@item
12449A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12450reproduce the bug.
12451
12452@item
12453A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12454incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12455
12456Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12457will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12458not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12459a chance to make a mistake.
12460
12461Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12462say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12463copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12464the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12465crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12466ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12467us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12468to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12469
c906108c
SS
12470@item
12471If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12472diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12473it by context, not by line number.
12474
12475The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12476sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 12477
c906108c
SS
12478@end itemize
12479
12480Here are some things that are not necessary:
12481
12482@itemize @bullet
12483@item
12484A description of the envelope of the bug.
12485
12486Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12487which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12488changes will not affect it.
12489
12490This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12491will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12492with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12493We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12494
12495Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12496of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12497output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12498less time, and so on.
12499
12500However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12501report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12502
12503@item
12504A patch for the bug.
12505
12506A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12507the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12508a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12509to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12510
12511Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12512construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12513through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12514to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12515
12516And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12517patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12518help us to understand.
12519
12520@item
12521A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12522
12523Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12524things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12525@end itemize
12526
5d161b24 12527@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
12528@c and consists of the two following files:
12529@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12530@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12531@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12532@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12533@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12534@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12535
12536
6d2ebf8b 12537@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
12538@appendix Formatting Documentation
12539
12540@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12541@cindex reference card
12542The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12543for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12544subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12545@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12546release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12547you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12548
12549The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12550can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12551
12552@example
12553make refcard.dvi
12554@end example
12555
5d161b24
DB
12556The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12557mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
12558that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12559high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12560your @sc{dvi} output program.
12561
12562@cindex documentation
12563
12564All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12565distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12566a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12567on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12568formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12569and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12570
12571@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12572version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12573file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12574subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12575necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12576but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12577Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12578@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12579
12580If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12581Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12582@code{makeinfo}.
12583
12584If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12585@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12586version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12587
12588@example
12589cd gdb
12590make gdb.info
12591@end example
12592
12593If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12594a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12595Texinfo definitions file.
12596
12597@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12598produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12599document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12600has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12601command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12602(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12603require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12604
12605@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12606@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12607written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12608typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12609and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12610directory.
12611
12612If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12613typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12614subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12615@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12616
12617@example
12618make gdb.dvi
12619@end example
12620
12621Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 12622
6d2ebf8b 12623@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
12624@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12625@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12626@cindex installation
12627
c906108c
SS
12628@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12629of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12630build the @code{gdb} program.
12631@iftex
12632@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12633@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12634look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12635installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12636@end iftex
12637
5d161b24
DB
12638The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12639@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
12640appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12641
12642For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12643@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12644
12645@table @code
12646@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12647script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12648
12649@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12650the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12651
12652@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12653source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12654
12655@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12656@sc{gnu} include files
12657
12658@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12659source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12660
12661@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12662source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12663
12664@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12665source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12666
12667@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12668source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12669
12670@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12671source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12672@end table
12673
12674The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12675from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12676this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12677
12678First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12679if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12680identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12681argument.
12682
12683For example:
12684
12685@example
12686cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12687./configure @var{host}
12688make
12689@end example
12690
12691@noindent
12692where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12693@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12694(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12695correct value by examining your system.)
12696
12697Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12698@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12699libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12700binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12701
12702@need 750
12703@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12704system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12705shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12706
12707@example
12708sh configure @var{host}
12709@end example
12710
12711If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12712directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12713@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12714creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12715you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12716
12717You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12718subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12719configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12720
12721For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12722the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12723
12724@example
12725@group
12726cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12727../configure @var{host}
12728@end group
12729@end example
12730
12731You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12732However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12733the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12734that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12735let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12736
12737@menu
12738* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12739* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12740* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12741@end menu
12742
6d2ebf8b 12743@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
12744@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12745
12746If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12747you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12748host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12749allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12750rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12751handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12752@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12753program specified there.
12754
12755To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12756with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12757(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12758itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12759would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12760the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12761
5d161b24 12762For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
12763separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12764
12765@example
12766@group
12767cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12768mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12769cd ../gdb-sun4
12770../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12771make
12772@end group
12773@end example
12774
12775When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12776directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12777(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12778the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12779directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12780@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12781
12782One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
12783directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12784@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12785programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
12786You specify a cross-debugging target by
12787giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12788
12789When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12790it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12791called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12792
12793The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12794directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12795directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12796directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12797will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12798
12799When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12800directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12801if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12802with each other.
12803
6d2ebf8b 12804@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
12805@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12806
12807The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12808script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12809aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12810of information in the following pattern:
12811
12812@example
12813@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12814@end example
12815
12816For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12817or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12818option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12819
12820The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12821any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12822aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12823@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12824script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12825abbreviations---for example:
12826
12827@smallexample
12828% sh config.sub i386-linux
12829i386-pc-linux-gnu
12830% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12831alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12832% sh config.sub hp9k700
12833hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12834% sh config.sub sun4
12835sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12836% sh config.sub sun3
12837m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12838% sh config.sub i986v
12839Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12840@end smallexample
12841
12842@noindent
12843@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12844directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12845
6d2ebf8b 12846@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
12847@section @code{configure} options
12848
12849Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12850are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12851several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12852Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12853
12854@example
12855configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12856 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12857 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12858 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12859 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12860 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12861 @var{host}
12862@end example
12863
12864@noindent
12865You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12866@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12867@samp{--}.
12868
12869@table @code
12870@item --help
12871Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12872
12873@item --prefix=@var{dir}
12874Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12875@file{@var{dir}}.
12876
12877@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12878Configure the source to install programs under directory
12879@file{@var{dir}}.
12880
12881@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12882@need 2000
12883@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12884@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12885@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12886Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12887@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12888build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12889directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12890the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12891directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12892the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12893@var{dirname}.
12894
12895@item --norecursion
12896Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12897propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12898
12899@item --target=@var{target}
12900Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12901@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12902programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12903
12904There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12905
12906@item @var{host} @dots{}
12907Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12908
12909There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12910@end table
12911
12912There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12913needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 12914
6d2ebf8b 12915@node Index
c906108c
SS
12916@unnumbered Index
12917
12918@printindex cp
12919
12920@tex
12921% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12922% meantime:
12923\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12924\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12925\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12926\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12927\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12928\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12929\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12930\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12931\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12932\page\colophon
12933% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12934@end tex
12935
449f3b6c
AC
12936@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
12937@ifinfo
c906108c 12938@contents
449f3b6c
AC
12939@end ifinfo
12940@ifhtml
12941@contents
12942@end ifhtml
12943
c906108c 12944@bye
This page took 0.677287 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.